1 //===---- TargetInfo.cpp - Encapsulate target details -----------*- C++ -*-===//
2 //
3 //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 // These classes wrap the information about a call or function
11 // definition used to handle ABI compliancy.
12 //
13 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
14 
15 #include "TargetInfo.h"
16 #include "ABIInfo.h"
17 #include "CGCXXABI.h"
18 #include "CGValue.h"
19 #include "CodeGenFunction.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/RecordLayout.h"
21 #include "clang/CodeGen/CGFunctionInfo.h"
22 #include "clang/CodeGen/SwiftCallingConv.h"
23 #include "clang/Frontend/CodeGenOptions.h"
24 #include "llvm/ADT/StringExtras.h"
25 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
26 #include "llvm/IR/DataLayout.h"
27 #include "llvm/IR/Type.h"
28 #include "llvm/Support/raw_ostream.h"
29 #include <algorithm>    // std::sort
30 
31 using namespace clang;
32 using namespace CodeGen;
33 
34 // Helper for coercing an aggregate argument or return value into an integer
35 // array of the same size (including padding) and alignment.  This alternate
36 // coercion happens only for the RenderScript ABI and can be removed after
37 // runtimes that rely on it are no longer supported.
38 //
39 // RenderScript assumes that the size of the argument / return value in the IR
40 // is the same as the size of the corresponding qualified type. This helper
41 // coerces the aggregate type into an array of the same size (including
42 // padding).  This coercion is used in lieu of expansion of struct members or
43 // other canonical coercions that return a coerced-type of larger size.
44 //
45 // Ty          - The argument / return value type
46 // Context     - The associated ASTContext
47 // LLVMContext - The associated LLVMContext
48 static ABIArgInfo coerceToIntArray(QualType Ty,
49                                    ASTContext &Context,
50                                    llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext) {
51   // Alignment and Size are measured in bits.
52   const uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty);
53   const uint64_t Alignment = Context.getTypeAlign(Ty);
54   llvm::Type *IntType = llvm::Type::getIntNTy(LLVMContext, Alignment);
55   const uint64_t NumElements = (Size + Alignment - 1) / Alignment;
56   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(IntType, NumElements));
57 }
58 
59 static void AssignToArrayRange(CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder,
60                                llvm::Value *Array,
61                                llvm::Value *Value,
62                                unsigned FirstIndex,
63                                unsigned LastIndex) {
64   // Alternatively, we could emit this as a loop in the source.
65   for (unsigned I = FirstIndex; I <= LastIndex; ++I) {
66     llvm::Value *Cell =
67         Builder.CreateConstInBoundsGEP1_32(Builder.getInt8Ty(), Array, I);
68     Builder.CreateAlignedStore(Value, Cell, CharUnits::One());
69   }
70 }
71 
72 static bool isAggregateTypeForABI(QualType T) {
73   return !CodeGenFunction::hasScalarEvaluationKind(T) ||
74          T->isMemberFunctionPointerType();
75 }
76 
77 ABIArgInfo
78 ABIInfo::getNaturalAlignIndirect(QualType Ty, bool ByRef, bool Realign,
79                                  llvm::Type *Padding) const {
80   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty),
81                                  ByRef, Realign, Padding);
82 }
83 
84 ABIArgInfo
85 ABIInfo::getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(QualType Ty, bool Realign) const {
86   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirectInReg(getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty),
87                                       /*ByRef*/ false, Realign);
88 }
89 
90 Address ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
91                              QualType Ty) const {
92   return Address::invalid();
93 }
94 
95 ABIInfo::~ABIInfo() {}
96 
97 /// Does the given lowering require more than the given number of
98 /// registers when expanded?
99 ///
100 /// This is intended to be the basis of a reasonable basic implementation
101 /// of should{Pass,Return}IndirectlyForSwift.
102 ///
103 /// For most targets, a limit of four total registers is reasonable; this
104 /// limits the amount of code required in order to move around the value
105 /// in case it wasn't produced immediately prior to the call by the caller
106 /// (or wasn't produced in exactly the right registers) or isn't used
107 /// immediately within the callee.  But some targets may need to further
108 /// limit the register count due to an inability to support that many
109 /// return registers.
110 static bool occupiesMoreThan(CodeGenTypes &cgt,
111                              ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalarTypes,
112                              unsigned maxAllRegisters) {
113   unsigned intCount = 0, fpCount = 0;
114   for (llvm::Type *type : scalarTypes) {
115     if (type->isPointerTy()) {
116       intCount++;
117     } else if (auto intTy = dyn_cast<llvm::IntegerType>(type)) {
118       auto ptrWidth = cgt.getTarget().getPointerWidth(0);
119       intCount += (intTy->getBitWidth() + ptrWidth - 1) / ptrWidth;
120     } else {
121       assert(type->isVectorTy() || type->isFloatingPointTy());
122       fpCount++;
123     }
124   }
125 
126   return (intCount + fpCount > maxAllRegisters);
127 }
128 
129 bool SwiftABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits vectorSize,
130                                              llvm::Type *eltTy,
131                                              unsigned numElts) const {
132   // The default implementation of this assumes that the target guarantees
133   // 128-bit SIMD support but nothing more.
134   return (vectorSize.getQuantity() > 8 && vectorSize.getQuantity() <= 16);
135 }
136 
137 static CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI getRecordArgABI(const RecordType *RT,
138                                               CGCXXABI &CXXABI) {
139   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl());
140   if (!RD)
141     return CGCXXABI::RAA_Default;
142   return CXXABI.getRecordArgABI(RD);
143 }
144 
145 static CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI getRecordArgABI(QualType T,
146                                               CGCXXABI &CXXABI) {
147   const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>();
148   if (!RT)
149     return CGCXXABI::RAA_Default;
150   return getRecordArgABI(RT, CXXABI);
151 }
152 
153 /// Pass transparent unions as if they were the type of the first element. Sema
154 /// should ensure that all elements of the union have the same "machine type".
155 static QualType useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(QualType Ty) {
156   if (const RecordType *UT = Ty->getAsUnionType()) {
157     const RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
158     if (UD->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) {
159       assert(!UD->field_empty() && "sema created an empty transparent union");
160       return UD->field_begin()->getType();
161     }
162   }
163   return Ty;
164 }
165 
166 CGCXXABI &ABIInfo::getCXXABI() const {
167   return CGT.getCXXABI();
168 }
169 
170 ASTContext &ABIInfo::getContext() const {
171   return CGT.getContext();
172 }
173 
174 llvm::LLVMContext &ABIInfo::getVMContext() const {
175   return CGT.getLLVMContext();
176 }
177 
178 const llvm::DataLayout &ABIInfo::getDataLayout() const {
179   return CGT.getDataLayout();
180 }
181 
182 const TargetInfo &ABIInfo::getTarget() const {
183   return CGT.getTarget();
184 }
185 
186 bool ABIInfo:: isAndroid() const { return getTarget().getTriple().isAndroid(); }
187 
188 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
189   return false;
190 }
191 
192 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base,
193                                                 uint64_t Members) const {
194   return false;
195 }
196 
197 bool ABIInfo::shouldSignExtUnsignedType(QualType Ty) const {
198   return false;
199 }
200 
201 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void ABIArgInfo::dump() const {
202   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
203   OS << "(ABIArgInfo Kind=";
204   switch (TheKind) {
205   case Direct:
206     OS << "Direct Type=";
207     if (llvm::Type *Ty = getCoerceToType())
208       Ty->print(OS);
209     else
210       OS << "null";
211     break;
212   case Extend:
213     OS << "Extend";
214     break;
215   case Ignore:
216     OS << "Ignore";
217     break;
218   case InAlloca:
219     OS << "InAlloca Offset=" << getInAllocaFieldIndex();
220     break;
221   case Indirect:
222     OS << "Indirect Align=" << getIndirectAlign().getQuantity()
223        << " ByVal=" << getIndirectByVal()
224        << " Realign=" << getIndirectRealign();
225     break;
226   case Expand:
227     OS << "Expand";
228     break;
229   case CoerceAndExpand:
230     OS << "CoerceAndExpand Type=";
231     getCoerceAndExpandType()->print(OS);
232     break;
233   }
234   OS << ")\n";
235 }
236 
237 // Dynamically round a pointer up to a multiple of the given alignment.
238 static llvm::Value *emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
239                                                   llvm::Value *Ptr,
240                                                   CharUnits Align) {
241   llvm::Value *PtrAsInt = Ptr;
242   // OverflowArgArea = (OverflowArgArea + Align - 1) & -Align;
243   PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(PtrAsInt, CGF.IntPtrTy);
244   PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(PtrAsInt,
245         llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.IntPtrTy, Align.getQuantity() - 1));
246   PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(PtrAsInt,
247            llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.IntPtrTy, -Align.getQuantity()));
248   PtrAsInt = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(PtrAsInt,
249                                         Ptr->getType(),
250                                         Ptr->getName() + ".aligned");
251   return PtrAsInt;
252 }
253 
254 /// Emit va_arg for a platform using the common void* representation,
255 /// where arguments are simply emitted in an array of slots on the stack.
256 ///
257 /// This version implements the core direct-value passing rules.
258 ///
259 /// \param SlotSize - The size and alignment of a stack slot.
260 ///   Each argument will be allocated to a multiple of this number of
261 ///   slots, and all the slots will be aligned to this value.
262 /// \param AllowHigherAlign - The slot alignment is not a cap;
263 ///   an argument type with an alignment greater than the slot size
264 ///   will be emitted on a higher-alignment address, potentially
265 ///   leaving one or more empty slots behind as padding.  If this
266 ///   is false, the returned address might be less-aligned than
267 ///   DirectAlign.
268 static Address emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
269                                       Address VAListAddr,
270                                       llvm::Type *DirectTy,
271                                       CharUnits DirectSize,
272                                       CharUnits DirectAlign,
273                                       CharUnits SlotSize,
274                                       bool AllowHigherAlign) {
275   // Cast the element type to i8* if necessary.  Some platforms define
276   // va_list as a struct containing an i8* instead of just an i8*.
277   if (VAListAddr.getElementType() != CGF.Int8PtrTy)
278     VAListAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(VAListAddr, CGF.Int8PtrTy);
279 
280   llvm::Value *Ptr = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "argp.cur");
281 
282   // If the CC aligns values higher than the slot size, do so if needed.
283   Address Addr = Address::invalid();
284   if (AllowHigherAlign && DirectAlign > SlotSize) {
285     Addr = Address(emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, Ptr, DirectAlign),
286                                                  DirectAlign);
287   } else {
288     Addr = Address(Ptr, SlotSize);
289   }
290 
291   // Advance the pointer past the argument, then store that back.
292   CharUnits FullDirectSize = DirectSize.alignTo(SlotSize);
293   llvm::Value *NextPtr =
294     CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr.getPointer(), FullDirectSize,
295                                            "argp.next");
296   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NextPtr, VAListAddr);
297 
298   // If the argument is smaller than a slot, and this is a big-endian
299   // target, the argument will be right-adjusted in its slot.
300   if (DirectSize < SlotSize && CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() &&
301       !DirectTy->isStructTy()) {
302     Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, SlotSize - DirectSize);
303   }
304 
305   Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, DirectTy);
306   return Addr;
307 }
308 
309 /// Emit va_arg for a platform using the common void* representation,
310 /// where arguments are simply emitted in an array of slots on the stack.
311 ///
312 /// \param IsIndirect - Values of this type are passed indirectly.
313 /// \param ValueInfo - The size and alignment of this type, generally
314 ///   computed with getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(ValueTy).
315 /// \param SlotSizeAndAlign - The size and alignment of a stack slot.
316 ///   Each argument will be allocated to a multiple of this number of
317 ///   slots, and all the slots will be aligned to this value.
318 /// \param AllowHigherAlign - The slot alignment is not a cap;
319 ///   an argument type with an alignment greater than the slot size
320 ///   will be emitted on a higher-alignment address, potentially
321 ///   leaving one or more empty slots behind as padding.
322 static Address emitVoidPtrVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
323                                 QualType ValueTy, bool IsIndirect,
324                                 std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> ValueInfo,
325                                 CharUnits SlotSizeAndAlign,
326                                 bool AllowHigherAlign) {
327   // The size and alignment of the value that was passed directly.
328   CharUnits DirectSize, DirectAlign;
329   if (IsIndirect) {
330     DirectSize = CGF.getPointerSize();
331     DirectAlign = CGF.getPointerAlign();
332   } else {
333     DirectSize = ValueInfo.first;
334     DirectAlign = ValueInfo.second;
335   }
336 
337   // Cast the address we've calculated to the right type.
338   llvm::Type *DirectTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(ValueTy);
339   if (IsIndirect)
340     DirectTy = DirectTy->getPointerTo(0);
341 
342   Address Addr = emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, DirectTy,
343                                         DirectSize, DirectAlign,
344                                         SlotSizeAndAlign,
345                                         AllowHigherAlign);
346 
347   if (IsIndirect) {
348     Addr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(Addr), ValueInfo.second);
349   }
350 
351   return Addr;
352 
353 }
354 
355 static Address emitMergePHI(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
356                             Address Addr1, llvm::BasicBlock *Block1,
357                             Address Addr2, llvm::BasicBlock *Block2,
358                             const llvm::Twine &Name = "") {
359   assert(Addr1.getType() == Addr2.getType());
360   llvm::PHINode *PHI = CGF.Builder.CreatePHI(Addr1.getType(), 2, Name);
361   PHI->addIncoming(Addr1.getPointer(), Block1);
362   PHI->addIncoming(Addr2.getPointer(), Block2);
363   CharUnits Align = std::min(Addr1.getAlignment(), Addr2.getAlignment());
364   return Address(PHI, Align);
365 }
366 
367 TargetCodeGenInfo::~TargetCodeGenInfo() { delete Info; }
368 
369 // If someone can figure out a general rule for this, that would be great.
370 // It's probably just doomed to be platform-dependent, though.
371 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getSizeOfUnwindException() const {
372   // Verified for:
373   //   x86-64     FreeBSD, Linux, Darwin
374   //   x86-32     FreeBSD, Linux, Darwin
375   //   PowerPC    Linux, Darwin
376   //   ARM        Darwin (*not* EABI)
377   //   AArch64    Linux
378   return 32;
379 }
380 
381 bool TargetCodeGenInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args,
382                                      const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const {
383   // The following conventions are known to require this to be false:
384   //   x86_stdcall
385   //   MIPS
386   // For everything else, we just prefer false unless we opt out.
387   return false;
388 }
389 
390 void
391 TargetCodeGenInfo::getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib,
392                                              llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const {
393   // This assumes the user is passing a library name like "rt" instead of a
394   // filename like "librt.a/so", and that they don't care whether it's static or
395   // dynamic.
396   Opt = "-l";
397   Opt += Lib;
398 }
399 
400 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const {
401   // OpenCL kernels are called via an explicit runtime API with arguments
402   // set with clSetKernelArg(), not as normal sub-functions.
403   // Return SPIR_KERNEL by default as the kernel calling convention to
404   // ensure the fingerprint is fixed such way that each OpenCL argument
405   // gets one matching argument in the produced kernel function argument
406   // list to enable feasible implementation of clSetKernelArg() with
407   // aggregates etc. In case we would use the default C calling conv here,
408   // clSetKernelArg() might break depending on the target-specific
409   // conventions; different targets might split structs passed as values
410   // to multiple function arguments etc.
411   return llvm::CallingConv::SPIR_KERNEL;
412 }
413 
414 llvm::Constant *TargetCodeGenInfo::getNullPointer(const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
415     llvm::PointerType *T, QualType QT) const {
416   return llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(T);
417 }
418 
419 unsigned TargetCodeGenInfo::getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM,
420                                                      const VarDecl *D) const {
421   assert(!CGM.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
422          !(CGM.getLangOpts().CUDA && CGM.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) &&
423          "Address space agnostic languages only");
424   return D ? D->getType().getAddressSpace()
425            : static_cast<unsigned>(LangAS::Default);
426 }
427 
428 llvm::Value *TargetCodeGenInfo::performAddrSpaceCast(
429     CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF, llvm::Value *Src, unsigned SrcAddr,
430     unsigned DestAddr, llvm::Type *DestTy, bool isNonNull) const {
431   // Since target may map different address spaces in AST to the same address
432   // space, an address space conversion may end up as a bitcast.
433   if (auto *C = dyn_cast<llvm::Constant>(Src))
434     return performAddrSpaceCast(CGF.CGM, C, SrcAddr, DestAddr, DestTy);
435   return CGF.Builder.CreatePointerBitCastOrAddrSpaceCast(Src, DestTy);
436 }
437 
438 llvm::Constant *
439 TargetCodeGenInfo::performAddrSpaceCast(CodeGenModule &CGM, llvm::Constant *Src,
440                                         unsigned SrcAddr, unsigned DestAddr,
441                                         llvm::Type *DestTy) const {
442   // Since target may map different address spaces in AST to the same address
443   // space, an address space conversion may end up as a bitcast.
444   return llvm::ConstantExpr::getPointerCast(Src, DestTy);
445 }
446 
447 static bool isEmptyRecord(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, bool AllowArrays);
448 
449 /// isEmptyField - Return true iff a the field is "empty", that is it
450 /// is an unnamed bit-field or an (array of) empty record(s).
451 static bool isEmptyField(ASTContext &Context, const FieldDecl *FD,
452                          bool AllowArrays) {
453   if (FD->isUnnamedBitfield())
454     return true;
455 
456   QualType FT = FD->getType();
457 
458   // Constant arrays of empty records count as empty, strip them off.
459   // Constant arrays of zero length always count as empty.
460   if (AllowArrays)
461     while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) {
462       if (AT->getSize() == 0)
463         return true;
464       FT = AT->getElementType();
465     }
466 
467   const RecordType *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>();
468   if (!RT)
469     return false;
470 
471   // C++ record fields are never empty, at least in the Itanium ABI.
472   //
473   // FIXME: We should use a predicate for whether this behavior is true in the
474   // current ABI.
475   if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl()))
476     return false;
477 
478   return isEmptyRecord(Context, FT, AllowArrays);
479 }
480 
481 /// isEmptyRecord - Return true iff a structure contains only empty
482 /// fields. Note that a structure with a flexible array member is not
483 /// considered empty.
484 static bool isEmptyRecord(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, bool AllowArrays) {
485   const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>();
486   if (!RT)
487     return false;
488   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
489   if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
490     return false;
491 
492   // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
493   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
494     for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases())
495       if (!isEmptyRecord(Context, I.getType(), true))
496         return false;
497 
498   for (const auto *I : RD->fields())
499     if (!isEmptyField(Context, I, AllowArrays))
500       return false;
501   return true;
502 }
503 
504 /// isSingleElementStruct - Determine if a structure is a "single
505 /// element struct", i.e. it has exactly one non-empty field or
506 /// exactly one field which is itself a single element
507 /// struct. Structures with flexible array members are never
508 /// considered single element structs.
509 ///
510 /// \return The field declaration for the single non-empty field, if
511 /// it exists.
512 static const Type *isSingleElementStruct(QualType T, ASTContext &Context) {
513   const RecordType *RT = T->getAs<RecordType>();
514   if (!RT)
515     return nullptr;
516 
517   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
518   if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
519     return nullptr;
520 
521   const Type *Found = nullptr;
522 
523   // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
524   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
525     for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) {
526       // Ignore empty records.
527       if (isEmptyRecord(Context, I.getType(), true))
528         continue;
529 
530       // If we already found an element then this isn't a single-element struct.
531       if (Found)
532         return nullptr;
533 
534       // If this is non-empty and not a single element struct, the composite
535       // cannot be a single element struct.
536       Found = isSingleElementStruct(I.getType(), Context);
537       if (!Found)
538         return nullptr;
539     }
540   }
541 
542   // Check for single element.
543   for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
544     QualType FT = FD->getType();
545 
546     // Ignore empty fields.
547     if (isEmptyField(Context, FD, true))
548       continue;
549 
550     // If we already found an element then this isn't a single-element
551     // struct.
552     if (Found)
553       return nullptr;
554 
555     // Treat single element arrays as the element.
556     while (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) {
557       if (AT->getSize().getZExtValue() != 1)
558         break;
559       FT = AT->getElementType();
560     }
561 
562     if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(FT)) {
563       Found = FT.getTypePtr();
564     } else {
565       Found = isSingleElementStruct(FT, Context);
566       if (!Found)
567         return nullptr;
568     }
569   }
570 
571   // We don't consider a struct a single-element struct if it has
572   // padding beyond the element type.
573   if (Found && Context.getTypeSize(Found) != Context.getTypeSize(T))
574     return nullptr;
575 
576   return Found;
577 }
578 
579 namespace {
580 Address EmitVAArgInstr(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty,
581                        const ABIArgInfo &AI) {
582   // This default implementation defers to the llvm backend's va_arg
583   // instruction. It can handle only passing arguments directly
584   // (typically only handled in the backend for primitive types), or
585   // aggregates passed indirectly by pointer (NOTE: if the "byval"
586   // flag has ABI impact in the callee, this implementation cannot
587   // work.)
588 
589   // Only a few cases are covered here at the moment -- those needed
590   // by the default abi.
591   llvm::Value *Val;
592 
593   if (AI.isIndirect()) {
594     assert(!AI.getPaddingType() &&
595            "Unexpected PaddingType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
596     assert(
597         !AI.getIndirectRealign() &&
598         "Unexpected IndirectRealign seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
599 
600     auto TyInfo = CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
601     CharUnits TyAlignForABI = TyInfo.second;
602 
603     llvm::Type *BaseTy =
604         llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty));
605     llvm::Value *Addr =
606         CGF.Builder.CreateVAArg(VAListAddr.getPointer(), BaseTy);
607     return Address(Addr, TyAlignForABI);
608   } else {
609     assert((AI.isDirect() || AI.isExtend()) &&
610            "Unexpected ArgInfo Kind in generic VAArg emitter!");
611 
612     assert(!AI.getInReg() &&
613            "Unexpected InReg seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
614     assert(!AI.getPaddingType() &&
615            "Unexpected PaddingType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
616     assert(!AI.getDirectOffset() &&
617            "Unexpected DirectOffset seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
618     assert(!AI.getCoerceToType() &&
619            "Unexpected CoerceToType seen in arginfo in generic VAArg emitter!");
620 
621     Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty, "varet");
622     Val = CGF.Builder.CreateVAArg(VAListAddr.getPointer(), CGF.ConvertType(Ty));
623     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(Val, Temp);
624     return Temp;
625   }
626 }
627 
628 /// DefaultABIInfo - The default implementation for ABI specific
629 /// details. This implementation provides information which results in
630 /// self-consistent and sensible LLVM IR generation, but does not
631 /// conform to any particular ABI.
632 class DefaultABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
633 public:
634   DefaultABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {}
635 
636   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
637   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const;
638 
639   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
640     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
641       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
642     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
643       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
644   }
645 
646   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
647                     QualType Ty) const override {
648     return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, classifyArgumentType(Ty));
649   }
650 };
651 
652 class DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
653 public:
654   DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
655     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {}
656 };
657 
658 ABIArgInfo DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
659   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
660 
661   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
662     // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be
663     // passed by value.
664     if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
665       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
666 
667     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
668   }
669 
670   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
671   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
672     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
673 
674   return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
675           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
676 }
677 
678 ABIArgInfo DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
679   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
680     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
681 
682   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy))
683     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
684 
685   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
686   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
687     RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
688 
689   return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
690           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
691 }
692 
693 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
694 // WebAssembly ABI Implementation
695 //
696 // This is a very simple ABI that relies a lot on DefaultABIInfo.
697 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
698 
699 class WebAssemblyABIInfo final : public DefaultABIInfo {
700 public:
701   explicit WebAssemblyABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
702       : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
703 
704 private:
705   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
706   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
707 
708   // DefaultABIInfo's classifyReturnType and classifyArgumentType are
709   // non-virtual, but computeInfo and EmitVAArg are virtual, so we
710   // overload them.
711   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
712     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
713       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
714     for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments())
715       Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type);
716   }
717 
718   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
719                     QualType Ty) const override;
720 };
721 
722 class WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo final : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
723 public:
724   explicit WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
725       : TargetCodeGenInfo(new WebAssemblyABIInfo(CGT)) {}
726 };
727 
728 /// \brief Classify argument of given type \p Ty.
729 ABIArgInfo WebAssemblyABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
730   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
731 
732   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
733     // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be
734     // passed by value.
735     if (auto RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
736       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
737     // Ignore empty structs/unions.
738     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
739       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
740     // Lower single-element structs to just pass a regular value. TODO: We
741     // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using getExpand(),
742     // though watch out for things like bitfields.
743     if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()))
744       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0)));
745   }
746 
747   // Otherwise just do the default thing.
748   return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty);
749 }
750 
751 ABIArgInfo WebAssemblyABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
752   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
753     // Records with non-trivial destructors/copy-constructors should not be
754     // returned by value.
755     if (!getRecordArgABI(RetTy, getCXXABI())) {
756       // Ignore empty structs/unions.
757       if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true))
758         return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
759       // Lower single-element structs to just return a regular value. TODO: We
760       // could do reasonable-size multiple-element structs too, using
761       // ABIArgInfo::getDirect().
762       if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext()))
763         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0)));
764     }
765   }
766 
767   // Otherwise just do the default thing.
768   return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(RetTy);
769 }
770 
771 Address WebAssemblyABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
772                                       QualType Ty) const {
773   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect=*/ false,
774                           getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty),
775                           CharUnits::fromQuantity(4),
776                           /*AllowHigherAlign=*/ true);
777 }
778 
779 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
780 // le32/PNaCl bitcode ABI Implementation
781 //
782 // This is a simplified version of the x86_32 ABI.  Arguments and return values
783 // are always passed on the stack.
784 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
785 
786 class PNaClABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
787  public:
788   PNaClABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {}
789 
790   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
791   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const;
792 
793   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
794   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
795                     Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) const override;
796 };
797 
798 class PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
799  public:
800   PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
801     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PNaClABIInfo(CGT)) {}
802 };
803 
804 void PNaClABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
805   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
806     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
807 
808   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
809     I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
810 }
811 
812 Address PNaClABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
813                                 QualType Ty) const {
814   // The PNaCL ABI is a bit odd, in that varargs don't use normal
815   // function classification. Structs get passed directly for varargs
816   // functions, through a rewriting transform in
817   // pnacl-llvm/lib/Transforms/NaCl/ExpandVarArgs.cpp, which allows
818   // this target to actually support a va_arg instructions with an
819   // aggregate type, unlike other targets.
820   return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
821 }
822 
823 /// \brief Classify argument of given type \p Ty.
824 ABIArgInfo PNaClABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
825   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
826     if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
827       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
828     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
829   } else if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) {
830     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
831     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
832   } else if (Ty->isFloatingType()) {
833     // Floating-point types don't go inreg.
834     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
835   }
836 
837   return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
838           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
839 }
840 
841 ABIArgInfo PNaClABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
842   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
843     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
844 
845   // In the PNaCl ABI we always return records/structures on the stack.
846   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy))
847     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
848 
849   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
850   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
851     RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
852 
853   return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
854           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
855 }
856 
857 /// IsX86_MMXType - Return true if this is an MMX type.
858 bool IsX86_MMXType(llvm::Type *IRType) {
859   // Return true if the type is an MMX type <2 x i32>, <4 x i16>, or <8 x i8>.
860   return IRType->isVectorTy() && IRType->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() == 64 &&
861     cast<llvm::VectorType>(IRType)->getElementType()->isIntegerTy() &&
862     IRType->getScalarSizeInBits() != 64;
863 }
864 
865 static llvm::Type* X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
866                                           StringRef Constraint,
867                                           llvm::Type* Ty) {
868   if ((Constraint == "y" || Constraint == "&y") && Ty->isVectorTy()) {
869     if (cast<llvm::VectorType>(Ty)->getBitWidth() != 64) {
870       // Invalid MMX constraint
871       return nullptr;
872     }
873 
874     return llvm::Type::getX86_MMXTy(CGF.getLLVMContext());
875   }
876 
877   // No operation needed
878   return Ty;
879 }
880 
881 /// Returns true if this type can be passed in SSE registers with the
882 /// X86_VectorCall calling convention. Shared between x86_32 and x86_64.
883 static bool isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) {
884   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
885     if (BT->isFloatingPoint() && BT->getKind() != BuiltinType::Half)
886       return true;
887   } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
888     // vectorcall can pass XMM, YMM, and ZMM vectors. We don't pass SSE1 MMX
889     // registers specially.
890     unsigned VecSize = Context.getTypeSize(VT);
891     if (VecSize == 128 || VecSize == 256 || VecSize == 512)
892       return true;
893   }
894   return false;
895 }
896 
897 /// Returns true if this aggregate is small enough to be passed in SSE registers
898 /// in the X86_VectorCall calling convention. Shared between x86_32 and x86_64.
899 static bool isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(uint64_t NumMembers) {
900   return NumMembers <= 4;
901 }
902 
903 /// Returns a Homogeneous Vector Aggregate ABIArgInfo, used in X86.
904 static ABIArgInfo getDirectX86Hva(llvm::Type* T = nullptr) {
905   auto AI = ABIArgInfo::getDirect(T);
906   AI.setInReg(true);
907   AI.setCanBeFlattened(false);
908   return AI;
909 }
910 
911 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
912 // X86-32 ABI Implementation
913 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
914 
915 /// \brief Similar to llvm::CCState, but for Clang.
916 struct CCState {
917   CCState(unsigned CC) : CC(CC), FreeRegs(0), FreeSSERegs(0) {}
918 
919   unsigned CC;
920   unsigned FreeRegs;
921   unsigned FreeSSERegs;
922 };
923 
924 enum {
925   // Vectorcall only allows the first 6 parameters to be passed in registers.
926   VectorcallMaxParamNumAsReg = 6
927 };
928 
929 /// X86_32ABIInfo - The X86-32 ABI information.
930 class X86_32ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
931   enum Class {
932     Integer,
933     Float
934   };
935 
936   static const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4;
937 
938   bool IsDarwinVectorABI;
939   bool IsRetSmallStructInRegABI;
940   bool IsWin32StructABI;
941   bool IsSoftFloatABI;
942   bool IsMCUABI;
943   unsigned DefaultNumRegisterParameters;
944 
945   static bool isRegisterSize(unsigned Size) {
946     return (Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32 || Size == 64);
947   }
948 
949   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override {
950     // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use.
951     return isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(getContext(), Ty);
952   }
953 
954   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty,
955                                          uint64_t NumMembers) const override {
956     // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use.
957     return isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(NumMembers);
958   }
959 
960   bool shouldReturnTypeInRegister(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context) const;
961 
962   /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result
963   /// such that the argument will be passed in memory.
964   ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, CCState &State) const;
965 
966   ABIArgInfo getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const;
967 
968   /// \brief Return the alignment to use for the given type on the stack.
969   unsigned getTypeStackAlignInBytes(QualType Ty, unsigned Align) const;
970 
971   Class classify(QualType Ty) const;
972   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const;
973   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const;
974 
975   /// \brief Updates the number of available free registers, returns
976   /// true if any registers were allocated.
977   bool updateFreeRegs(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const;
978 
979   bool shouldAggregateUseDirect(QualType Ty, CCState &State, bool &InReg,
980                                 bool &NeedsPadding) const;
981   bool shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const;
982 
983   bool canExpandIndirectArgument(QualType Ty) const;
984 
985   /// \brief Rewrite the function info so that all memory arguments use
986   /// inalloca.
987   void rewriteWithInAlloca(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const;
988 
989   void addFieldToArgStruct(SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> &FrameFields,
990                            CharUnits &StackOffset, ABIArgInfo &Info,
991                            QualType Type) const;
992   void computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, CCState &State,
993                              bool &UsedInAlloca) const;
994 
995 public:
996 
997   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
998   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
999                     QualType Ty) const override;
1000 
1001   X86_32ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool DarwinVectorABI,
1002                 bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI,
1003                 unsigned NumRegisterParameters, bool SoftFloatABI)
1004     : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), IsDarwinVectorABI(DarwinVectorABI),
1005       IsRetSmallStructInRegABI(RetSmallStructInRegABI),
1006       IsWin32StructABI(Win32StructABI),
1007       IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI),
1008       IsMCUABI(CGT.getTarget().getTriple().isOSIAMCU()),
1009       DefaultNumRegisterParameters(NumRegisterParameters) {}
1010 
1011   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize,
1012                                     ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
1013                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
1014     // LLVM's x86-32 lowering currently only assigns up to three
1015     // integer registers and three fp registers.  Oddly, it'll use up to
1016     // four vector registers for vectors, but those can overlap with the
1017     // scalar registers.
1018     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 3);
1019   }
1020 
1021   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
1022     // x86-32 lowering does not support passing swifterror in a register.
1023     return false;
1024   }
1025 };
1026 
1027 class X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
1028 public:
1029   X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool DarwinVectorABI,
1030                           bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI,
1031                           unsigned NumRegisterParameters, bool SoftFloatABI)
1032       : TargetCodeGenInfo(new X86_32ABIInfo(
1033             CGT, DarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI, Win32StructABI,
1034             NumRegisterParameters, SoftFloatABI)) {}
1035 
1036   static bool isStructReturnInRegABI(
1037       const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts);
1038 
1039   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
1040                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override;
1041 
1042   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
1043     // Darwin uses different dwarf register numbers for EH.
1044     if (CGM.getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) return 5;
1045     return 4;
1046   }
1047 
1048   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
1049                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
1050 
1051   llvm::Type* adjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
1052                                   StringRef Constraint,
1053                                   llvm::Type* Ty) const override {
1054     return X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CGF, Constraint, Ty);
1055   }
1056 
1057   void addReturnRegisterOutputs(CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue ReturnValue,
1058                                 std::string &Constraints,
1059                                 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultRegTypes,
1060                                 std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultTruncRegTypes,
1061                                 std::vector<LValue> &ResultRegDests,
1062                                 std::string &AsmString,
1063                                 unsigned NumOutputs) const override;
1064 
1065   llvm::Constant *
1066   getUBSanFunctionSignature(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
1067     unsigned Sig = (0xeb << 0) |  // jmp rel8
1068                    (0x06 << 8) |  //           .+0x08
1069                    ('F' << 16) |
1070                    ('T' << 24);
1071     return llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGM.Int32Ty, Sig);
1072   }
1073 
1074   StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override {
1075     return "movl\t%ebp, %ebp"
1076            "\t\t## marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue";
1077   }
1078 };
1079 
1080 }
1081 
1082 /// Rewrite input constraint references after adding some output constraints.
1083 /// In the case where there is one output and one input and we add one output,
1084 /// we need to replace all operand references greater than or equal to 1:
1085 ///     mov $0, $1
1086 ///     mov eax, $1
1087 /// The result will be:
1088 ///     mov $0, $2
1089 ///     mov eax, $2
1090 static void rewriteInputConstraintReferences(unsigned FirstIn,
1091                                              unsigned NumNewOuts,
1092                                              std::string &AsmString) {
1093   std::string Buf;
1094   llvm::raw_string_ostream OS(Buf);
1095   size_t Pos = 0;
1096   while (Pos < AsmString.size()) {
1097     size_t DollarStart = AsmString.find('$', Pos);
1098     if (DollarStart == std::string::npos)
1099       DollarStart = AsmString.size();
1100     size_t DollarEnd = AsmString.find_first_not_of('$', DollarStart);
1101     if (DollarEnd == std::string::npos)
1102       DollarEnd = AsmString.size();
1103     OS << StringRef(&AsmString[Pos], DollarEnd - Pos);
1104     Pos = DollarEnd;
1105     size_t NumDollars = DollarEnd - DollarStart;
1106     if (NumDollars % 2 != 0 && Pos < AsmString.size()) {
1107       // We have an operand reference.
1108       size_t DigitStart = Pos;
1109       size_t DigitEnd = AsmString.find_first_not_of("0123456789", DigitStart);
1110       if (DigitEnd == std::string::npos)
1111         DigitEnd = AsmString.size();
1112       StringRef OperandStr(&AsmString[DigitStart], DigitEnd - DigitStart);
1113       unsigned OperandIndex;
1114       if (!OperandStr.getAsInteger(10, OperandIndex)) {
1115         if (OperandIndex >= FirstIn)
1116           OperandIndex += NumNewOuts;
1117         OS << OperandIndex;
1118       } else {
1119         OS << OperandStr;
1120       }
1121       Pos = DigitEnd;
1122     }
1123   }
1124   AsmString = std::move(OS.str());
1125 }
1126 
1127 /// Add output constraints for EAX:EDX because they are return registers.
1128 void X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::addReturnRegisterOutputs(
1129     CodeGenFunction &CGF, LValue ReturnSlot, std::string &Constraints,
1130     std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultRegTypes,
1131     std::vector<llvm::Type *> &ResultTruncRegTypes,
1132     std::vector<LValue> &ResultRegDests, std::string &AsmString,
1133     unsigned NumOutputs) const {
1134   uint64_t RetWidth = CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(ReturnSlot.getType());
1135 
1136   // Use the EAX constraint if the width is 32 or smaller and EAX:EDX if it is
1137   // larger.
1138   if (!Constraints.empty())
1139     Constraints += ',';
1140   if (RetWidth <= 32) {
1141     Constraints += "={eax}";
1142     ResultRegTypes.push_back(CGF.Int32Ty);
1143   } else {
1144     // Use the 'A' constraint for EAX:EDX.
1145     Constraints += "=A";
1146     ResultRegTypes.push_back(CGF.Int64Ty);
1147   }
1148 
1149   // Truncate EAX or EAX:EDX to an integer of the appropriate size.
1150   llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(CGF.getLLVMContext(), RetWidth);
1151   ResultTruncRegTypes.push_back(CoerceTy);
1152 
1153   // Coerce the integer by bitcasting the return slot pointer.
1154   ReturnSlot.setAddress(CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(ReturnSlot.getAddress(),
1155                                                   CoerceTy->getPointerTo()));
1156   ResultRegDests.push_back(ReturnSlot);
1157 
1158   rewriteInputConstraintReferences(NumOutputs, 1, AsmString);
1159 }
1160 
1161 /// shouldReturnTypeInRegister - Determine if the given type should be
1162 /// returned in a register (for the Darwin and MCU ABI).
1163 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldReturnTypeInRegister(QualType Ty,
1164                                                ASTContext &Context) const {
1165   uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty);
1166 
1167   // For i386, type must be register sized.
1168   // For the MCU ABI, it only needs to be <= 8-byte
1169   if ((IsMCUABI && Size > 64) || (!IsMCUABI && !isRegisterSize(Size)))
1170    return false;
1171 
1172   if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
1173     // 64- and 128- bit vectors inside structures are not returned in
1174     // registers.
1175     if (Size == 64 || Size == 128)
1176       return false;
1177 
1178     return true;
1179   }
1180 
1181   // If this is a builtin, pointer, enum, complex type, member pointer, or
1182   // member function pointer it is ok.
1183   if (Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() || Ty->hasPointerRepresentation() ||
1184       Ty->isAnyComplexType() || Ty->isEnumeralType() ||
1185       Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType())
1186     return true;
1187 
1188   // Arrays are treated like records.
1189   if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(Ty))
1190     return shouldReturnTypeInRegister(AT->getElementType(), Context);
1191 
1192   // Otherwise, it must be a record type.
1193   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
1194   if (!RT) return false;
1195 
1196   // FIXME: Traverse bases here too.
1197 
1198   // Structure types are passed in register if all fields would be
1199   // passed in a register.
1200   for (const auto *FD : RT->getDecl()->fields()) {
1201     // Empty fields are ignored.
1202     if (isEmptyField(Context, FD, true))
1203       continue;
1204 
1205     // Check fields recursively.
1206     if (!shouldReturnTypeInRegister(FD->getType(), Context))
1207       return false;
1208   }
1209   return true;
1210 }
1211 
1212 static bool is32Or64BitBasicType(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context) {
1213   // Treat complex types as the element type.
1214   if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>())
1215     Ty = CTy->getElementType();
1216 
1217   // Check for a type which we know has a simple scalar argument-passing
1218   // convention without any padding.  (We're specifically looking for 32
1219   // and 64-bit integer and integer-equivalents, float, and double.)
1220   if (!Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() && !Ty->hasPointerRepresentation() &&
1221       !Ty->isEnumeralType() && !Ty->isBlockPointerType())
1222     return false;
1223 
1224   uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty);
1225   return Size == 32 || Size == 64;
1226 }
1227 
1228 static bool addFieldSizes(ASTContext &Context, const RecordDecl *RD,
1229                           uint64_t &Size) {
1230   for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
1231     // Scalar arguments on the stack get 4 byte alignment on x86. If the
1232     // argument is smaller than 32-bits, expanding the struct will create
1233     // alignment padding.
1234     if (!is32Or64BitBasicType(FD->getType(), Context))
1235       return false;
1236 
1237     // FIXME: Reject bit-fields wholesale; there are two problems, we don't know
1238     // how to expand them yet, and the predicate for telling if a bitfield still
1239     // counts as "basic" is more complicated than what we were doing previously.
1240     if (FD->isBitField())
1241       return false;
1242 
1243     Size += Context.getTypeSize(FD->getType());
1244   }
1245   return true;
1246 }
1247 
1248 static bool addBaseAndFieldSizes(ASTContext &Context, const CXXRecordDecl *RD,
1249                                  uint64_t &Size) {
1250   // Don't do this if there are any non-empty bases.
1251   for (const CXXBaseSpecifier &Base : RD->bases()) {
1252     if (!addBaseAndFieldSizes(Context, Base.getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(),
1253                               Size))
1254       return false;
1255   }
1256   if (!addFieldSizes(Context, RD, Size))
1257     return false;
1258   return true;
1259 }
1260 
1261 /// Test whether an argument type which is to be passed indirectly (on the
1262 /// stack) would have the equivalent layout if it was expanded into separate
1263 /// arguments. If so, we prefer to do the latter to avoid inhibiting
1264 /// optimizations.
1265 bool X86_32ABIInfo::canExpandIndirectArgument(QualType Ty) const {
1266   // We can only expand structure types.
1267   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
1268   if (!RT)
1269     return false;
1270   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1271   uint64_t Size = 0;
1272   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
1273     if (!IsWin32StructABI) {
1274       // On non-Windows, we have to conservatively match our old bitcode
1275       // prototypes in order to be ABI-compatible at the bitcode level.
1276       if (!CXXRD->isCLike())
1277         return false;
1278     } else {
1279       // Don't do this for dynamic classes.
1280       if (CXXRD->isDynamicClass())
1281         return false;
1282     }
1283     if (!addBaseAndFieldSizes(getContext(), CXXRD, Size))
1284       return false;
1285   } else {
1286     if (!addFieldSizes(getContext(), RD, Size))
1287       return false;
1288   }
1289 
1290   // We can do this if there was no alignment padding.
1291   return Size == getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
1292 }
1293 
1294 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::getIndirectReturnResult(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const {
1295   // If the return value is indirect, then the hidden argument is consuming one
1296   // integer register.
1297   if (State.FreeRegs) {
1298     --State.FreeRegs;
1299     if (!IsMCUABI)
1300       return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(RetTy);
1301   }
1302   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/false);
1303 }
1304 
1305 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy,
1306                                              CCState &State) const {
1307   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
1308     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
1309 
1310   const Type *Base = nullptr;
1311   uint64_t NumElts = 0;
1312   if ((State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall ||
1313        State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) &&
1314       isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, NumElts)) {
1315     // The LLVM struct type for such an aggregate should lower properly.
1316     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1317   }
1318 
1319   if (const VectorType *VT = RetTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
1320     // On Darwin, some vectors are returned in registers.
1321     if (IsDarwinVectorABI) {
1322       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
1323 
1324       // 128-bit vectors are a special case; they are returned in
1325       // registers and we need to make sure to pick a type the LLVM
1326       // backend will like.
1327       if (Size == 128)
1328         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::VectorType::get(
1329                   llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()), 2));
1330 
1331       // Always return in register if it fits in a general purpose
1332       // register, or if it is 64 bits and has a single element.
1333       if ((Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) ||
1334           (Size == 64 && VT->getNumElements() == 1))
1335         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),
1336                                                             Size));
1337 
1338       return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State);
1339     }
1340 
1341     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1342   }
1343 
1344   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
1345     if (const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
1346       // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect.
1347       if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
1348         return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State);
1349     }
1350 
1351     // If specified, structs and unions are always indirect.
1352     if (!IsRetSmallStructInRegABI && !RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
1353       return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State);
1354 
1355     // Ignore empty structs/unions.
1356     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true))
1357       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
1358 
1359     // Small structures which are register sized are generally returned
1360     // in a register.
1361     if (shouldReturnTypeInRegister(RetTy, getContext())) {
1362       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
1363 
1364       // As a special-case, if the struct is a "single-element" struct, and
1365       // the field is of type "float" or "double", return it in a
1366       // floating-point register. (MSVC does not apply this special case.)
1367       // We apply a similar transformation for pointer types to improve the
1368       // quality of the generated IR.
1369       if (const Type *SeltTy = isSingleElementStruct(RetTy, getContext()))
1370         if ((!IsWin32StructABI && SeltTy->isRealFloatingType())
1371             || SeltTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
1372           return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(SeltTy, 0)));
1373 
1374       // FIXME: We should be able to narrow this integer in cases with dead
1375       // padding.
1376       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),Size));
1377     }
1378 
1379     return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy, State);
1380   }
1381 
1382   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
1383   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
1384     RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1385 
1386   return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
1387           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
1388 }
1389 
1390 static bool isSSEVectorType(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) {
1391   return Ty->getAs<VectorType>() && Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == 128;
1392 }
1393 
1394 static bool isRecordWithSSEVectorType(ASTContext &Context, QualType Ty) {
1395   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
1396   if (!RT)
1397     return 0;
1398   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
1399 
1400   // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
1401   if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
1402     for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases())
1403       if (!isRecordWithSSEVectorType(Context, I.getType()))
1404         return false;
1405 
1406   for (const auto *i : RD->fields()) {
1407     QualType FT = i->getType();
1408 
1409     if (isSSEVectorType(Context, FT))
1410       return true;
1411 
1412     if (isRecordWithSSEVectorType(Context, FT))
1413       return true;
1414   }
1415 
1416   return false;
1417 }
1418 
1419 unsigned X86_32ABIInfo::getTypeStackAlignInBytes(QualType Ty,
1420                                                  unsigned Align) const {
1421   // Otherwise, if the alignment is less than or equal to the minimum ABI
1422   // alignment, just use the default; the backend will handle this.
1423   if (Align <= MinABIStackAlignInBytes)
1424     return 0; // Use default alignment.
1425 
1426   // On non-Darwin, the stack type alignment is always 4.
1427   if (!IsDarwinVectorABI) {
1428     // Set explicit alignment, since we may need to realign the top.
1429     return MinABIStackAlignInBytes;
1430   }
1431 
1432   // Otherwise, if the type contains an SSE vector type, the alignment is 16.
1433   if (Align >= 16 && (isSSEVectorType(getContext(), Ty) ||
1434                       isRecordWithSSEVectorType(getContext(), Ty)))
1435     return 16;
1436 
1437   return MinABIStackAlignInBytes;
1438 }
1439 
1440 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal,
1441                                             CCState &State) const {
1442   if (!ByVal) {
1443     if (State.FreeRegs) {
1444       --State.FreeRegs; // Non-byval indirects just use one pointer.
1445       if (!IsMCUABI)
1446         return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty);
1447     }
1448     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false);
1449   }
1450 
1451   // Compute the byval alignment.
1452   unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8;
1453   unsigned StackAlign = getTypeStackAlignInBytes(Ty, TypeAlign);
1454   if (StackAlign == 0)
1455     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true);
1456 
1457   // If the stack alignment is less than the type alignment, realign the
1458   // argument.
1459   bool Realign = TypeAlign > StackAlign;
1460   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(StackAlign),
1461                                  /*ByVal=*/true, Realign);
1462 }
1463 
1464 X86_32ABIInfo::Class X86_32ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty) const {
1465   const Type *T = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext());
1466   if (!T)
1467     T = Ty.getTypePtr();
1468 
1469   if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
1470     BuiltinType::Kind K = BT->getKind();
1471     if (K == BuiltinType::Float || K == BuiltinType::Double)
1472       return Float;
1473   }
1474   return Integer;
1475 }
1476 
1477 bool X86_32ABIInfo::updateFreeRegs(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const {
1478   if (!IsSoftFloatABI) {
1479     Class C = classify(Ty);
1480     if (C == Float)
1481       return false;
1482   }
1483 
1484   unsigned Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
1485   unsigned SizeInRegs = (Size + 31) / 32;
1486 
1487   if (SizeInRegs == 0)
1488     return false;
1489 
1490   if (!IsMCUABI) {
1491     if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs) {
1492       State.FreeRegs = 0;
1493       return false;
1494     }
1495   } else {
1496     // The MCU psABI allows passing parameters in-reg even if there are
1497     // earlier parameters that are passed on the stack. Also,
1498     // it does not allow passing >8-byte structs in-register,
1499     // even if there are 3 free registers available.
1500     if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs || SizeInRegs > 2)
1501       return false;
1502   }
1503 
1504   State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs;
1505   return true;
1506 }
1507 
1508 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldAggregateUseDirect(QualType Ty, CCState &State,
1509                                              bool &InReg,
1510                                              bool &NeedsPadding) const {
1511   // On Windows, aggregates other than HFAs are never passed in registers, and
1512   // they do not consume register slots. Homogenous floating-point aggregates
1513   // (HFAs) have already been dealt with at this point.
1514   if (IsWin32StructABI && isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty))
1515     return false;
1516 
1517   NeedsPadding = false;
1518   InReg = !IsMCUABI;
1519 
1520   if (!updateFreeRegs(Ty, State))
1521     return false;
1522 
1523   if (IsMCUABI)
1524     return true;
1525 
1526   if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall ||
1527       State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall ||
1528       State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) {
1529     if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 32 && State.FreeRegs)
1530       NeedsPadding = true;
1531 
1532     return false;
1533   }
1534 
1535   return true;
1536 }
1537 
1538 bool X86_32ABIInfo::shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const {
1539   if (!updateFreeRegs(Ty, State))
1540     return false;
1541 
1542   if (IsMCUABI)
1543     return false;
1544 
1545   if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall ||
1546       State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall ||
1547       State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) {
1548     if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) > 32)
1549       return false;
1550 
1551     return (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() || Ty->isPointerType() ||
1552         Ty->isReferenceType());
1553   }
1554 
1555   return true;
1556 }
1557 
1558 ABIArgInfo X86_32ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty,
1559                                                CCState &State) const {
1560   // FIXME: Set alignment on indirect arguments.
1561 
1562   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
1563 
1564   // Check with the C++ ABI first.
1565   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
1566   if (RT) {
1567     CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI());
1568     if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) {
1569       return getIndirectResult(Ty, false, State);
1570     } else if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) {
1571       // The field index doesn't matter, we'll fix it up later.
1572       return ABIArgInfo::getInAlloca(/*FieldIndex=*/0);
1573     }
1574   }
1575 
1576   // Regcall uses the concept of a homogenous vector aggregate, similar
1577   // to other targets.
1578   const Type *Base = nullptr;
1579   uint64_t NumElts = 0;
1580   if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall &&
1581       isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) {
1582 
1583     if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) {
1584       State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
1585       if (Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType())
1586         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1587       return ABIArgInfo::getExpand();
1588     }
1589     return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State);
1590   }
1591 
1592   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
1593     // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect.
1594     // FIXME: This should not be byval!
1595     if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
1596       return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State);
1597 
1598     // Ignore empty structs/unions on non-Windows.
1599     if (!IsWin32StructABI && isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
1600       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
1601 
1602     llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext();
1603     llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext);
1604     bool NeedsPadding = false;
1605     bool InReg;
1606     if (shouldAggregateUseDirect(Ty, State, InReg, NeedsPadding)) {
1607       unsigned SizeInRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32;
1608       SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32);
1609       llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements);
1610       if (InReg)
1611         return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result);
1612       else
1613         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Result);
1614     }
1615     llvm::IntegerType *PaddingType = NeedsPadding ? Int32 : nullptr;
1616 
1617     // Expand small (<= 128-bit) record types when we know that the stack layout
1618     // of those arguments will match the struct. This is important because the
1619     // LLVM backend isn't smart enough to remove byval, which inhibits many
1620     // optimizations.
1621     // Don't do this for the MCU if there are still free integer registers
1622     // (see X86_64 ABI for full explanation).
1623     if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 4 * 32 &&
1624         (!IsMCUABI || State.FreeRegs == 0) && canExpandIndirectArgument(Ty))
1625       return ABIArgInfo::getExpandWithPadding(
1626           State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall ||
1627               State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall ||
1628               State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall,
1629           PaddingType);
1630 
1631     return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State);
1632   }
1633 
1634   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
1635     // On Darwin, some vectors are passed in memory, we handle this by passing
1636     // it as an i8/i16/i32/i64.
1637     if (IsDarwinVectorABI) {
1638       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
1639       if ((Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) ||
1640           (Size == 64 && VT->getNumElements() == 1))
1641         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),
1642                                                             Size));
1643     }
1644 
1645     if (IsX86_MMXType(CGT.ConvertType(Ty)))
1646       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 64));
1647 
1648     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1649   }
1650 
1651 
1652   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
1653     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1654 
1655   bool InReg = shouldPrimitiveUseInReg(Ty, State);
1656 
1657   if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
1658     if (InReg)
1659       return ABIArgInfo::getExtendInReg();
1660     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend();
1661   }
1662 
1663   if (InReg)
1664     return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
1665   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1666 }
1667 
1668 void X86_32ABIInfo::computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, CCState &State,
1669                                           bool &UsedInAlloca) const {
1670   // Vectorcall x86 works subtly different than in x64, so the format is
1671   // a bit different than the x64 version.  First, all vector types (not HVAs)
1672   // are assigned, with the first 6 ending up in the YMM0-5 or XMM0-5 registers.
1673   // This differs from the x64 implementation, where the first 6 by INDEX get
1674   // registers.
1675   // After that, integers AND HVAs are assigned Left to Right in the same pass.
1676   // Integers are passed as ECX/EDX if one is available (in order).  HVAs will
1677   // first take up the remaining YMM/XMM registers. If insufficient registers
1678   // remain but an integer register (ECX/EDX) is available, it will be passed
1679   // in that, else, on the stack.
1680   for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) {
1681     // First pass do all the vector types.
1682     const Type *Base = nullptr;
1683     uint64_t NumElts = 0;
1684     const QualType& Ty = I.type;
1685     if ((Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isBuiltinType()) &&
1686         isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) {
1687       if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) {
1688         State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
1689         I.info = ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
1690       } else {
1691         I.info = classifyArgumentType(Ty, State);
1692       }
1693       UsedInAlloca |= (I.info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca);
1694     }
1695   }
1696 
1697   for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) {
1698     // Second pass, do the rest!
1699     const Type *Base = nullptr;
1700     uint64_t NumElts = 0;
1701     const QualType& Ty = I.type;
1702     bool IsHva = isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts);
1703 
1704     if (IsHva && !Ty->isVectorType() && !Ty->isBuiltinType()) {
1705       // Assign true HVAs (non vector/native FP types).
1706       if (State.FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) {
1707         State.FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
1708         I.info = getDirectX86Hva();
1709       } else {
1710         I.info = getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State);
1711       }
1712     } else if (!IsHva) {
1713       // Assign all Non-HVAs, so this will exclude Vector/FP args.
1714       I.info = classifyArgumentType(Ty, State);
1715       UsedInAlloca |= (I.info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca);
1716     }
1717   }
1718 }
1719 
1720 void X86_32ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
1721   CCState State(FI.getCallingConvention());
1722   if (IsMCUABI)
1723     State.FreeRegs = 3;
1724   else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_FastCall)
1725     State.FreeRegs = 2;
1726   else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall) {
1727     State.FreeRegs = 2;
1728     State.FreeSSERegs = 6;
1729   } else if (FI.getHasRegParm())
1730     State.FreeRegs = FI.getRegParm();
1731   else if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall) {
1732     State.FreeRegs = 5;
1733     State.FreeSSERegs = 8;
1734   } else
1735     State.FreeRegs = DefaultNumRegisterParameters;
1736 
1737   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI)) {
1738     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), State);
1739   } else if (FI.getReturnInfo().isIndirect()) {
1740     // The C++ ABI is not aware of register usage, so we have to check if the
1741     // return value was sret and put it in a register ourselves if appropriate.
1742     if (State.FreeRegs) {
1743       --State.FreeRegs;  // The sret parameter consumes a register.
1744       if (!IsMCUABI)
1745         FI.getReturnInfo().setInReg(true);
1746     }
1747   }
1748 
1749   // The chain argument effectively gives us another free register.
1750   if (FI.isChainCall())
1751     ++State.FreeRegs;
1752 
1753   bool UsedInAlloca = false;
1754   if (State.CC == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall) {
1755     computeVectorCallArgs(FI, State, UsedInAlloca);
1756   } else {
1757     // If not vectorcall, revert to normal behavior.
1758     for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) {
1759       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State);
1760       UsedInAlloca |= (I.info.getKind() == ABIArgInfo::InAlloca);
1761     }
1762   }
1763 
1764   // If we needed to use inalloca for any argument, do a second pass and rewrite
1765   // all the memory arguments to use inalloca.
1766   if (UsedInAlloca)
1767     rewriteWithInAlloca(FI);
1768 }
1769 
1770 void
1771 X86_32ABIInfo::addFieldToArgStruct(SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> &FrameFields,
1772                                    CharUnits &StackOffset, ABIArgInfo &Info,
1773                                    QualType Type) const {
1774   // Arguments are always 4-byte-aligned.
1775   CharUnits FieldAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
1776 
1777   assert(StackOffset.isMultipleOf(FieldAlign) && "unaligned inalloca struct");
1778   Info = ABIArgInfo::getInAlloca(FrameFields.size());
1779   FrameFields.push_back(CGT.ConvertTypeForMem(Type));
1780   StackOffset += getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Type);
1781 
1782   // Insert padding bytes to respect alignment.
1783   CharUnits FieldEnd = StackOffset;
1784   StackOffset = FieldEnd.alignTo(FieldAlign);
1785   if (StackOffset != FieldEnd) {
1786     CharUnits NumBytes = StackOffset - FieldEnd;
1787     llvm::Type *Ty = llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext());
1788     Ty = llvm::ArrayType::get(Ty, NumBytes.getQuantity());
1789     FrameFields.push_back(Ty);
1790   }
1791 }
1792 
1793 static bool isArgInAlloca(const ABIArgInfo &Info) {
1794   // Leave ignored and inreg arguments alone.
1795   switch (Info.getKind()) {
1796   case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca:
1797     return true;
1798   case ABIArgInfo::Indirect:
1799     assert(Info.getIndirectByVal());
1800     return true;
1801   case ABIArgInfo::Ignore:
1802     return false;
1803   case ABIArgInfo::Direct:
1804   case ABIArgInfo::Extend:
1805     if (Info.getInReg())
1806       return false;
1807     return true;
1808   case ABIArgInfo::Expand:
1809   case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand:
1810     // These are aggregate types which are never passed in registers when
1811     // inalloca is involved.
1812     return true;
1813   }
1814   llvm_unreachable("invalid enum");
1815 }
1816 
1817 void X86_32ABIInfo::rewriteWithInAlloca(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
1818   assert(IsWin32StructABI && "inalloca only supported on win32");
1819 
1820   // Build a packed struct type for all of the arguments in memory.
1821   SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 6> FrameFields;
1822 
1823   // The stack alignment is always 4.
1824   CharUnits StackAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
1825 
1826   CharUnits StackOffset;
1827   CGFunctionInfo::arg_iterator I = FI.arg_begin(), E = FI.arg_end();
1828 
1829   // Put 'this' into the struct before 'sret', if necessary.
1830   bool IsThisCall =
1831       FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_ThisCall;
1832   ABIArgInfo &Ret = FI.getReturnInfo();
1833   if (Ret.isIndirect() && Ret.isSRetAfterThis() && !IsThisCall &&
1834       isArgInAlloca(I->info)) {
1835     addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, I->info, I->type);
1836     ++I;
1837   }
1838 
1839   // Put the sret parameter into the inalloca struct if it's in memory.
1840   if (Ret.isIndirect() && !Ret.getInReg()) {
1841     CanQualType PtrTy = getContext().getPointerType(FI.getReturnType());
1842     addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, Ret, PtrTy);
1843     // On Windows, the hidden sret parameter is always returned in eax.
1844     Ret.setInAllocaSRet(IsWin32StructABI);
1845   }
1846 
1847   // Skip the 'this' parameter in ecx.
1848   if (IsThisCall)
1849     ++I;
1850 
1851   // Put arguments passed in memory into the struct.
1852   for (; I != E; ++I) {
1853     if (isArgInAlloca(I->info))
1854       addFieldToArgStruct(FrameFields, StackOffset, I->info, I->type);
1855   }
1856 
1857   FI.setArgStruct(llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), FrameFields,
1858                                         /*isPacked=*/true),
1859                   StackAlign);
1860 }
1861 
1862 Address X86_32ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
1863                                  Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) const {
1864 
1865   auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
1866 
1867   // x86-32 changes the alignment of certain arguments on the stack.
1868   //
1869   // Just messing with TypeInfo like this works because we never pass
1870   // anything indirectly.
1871   TypeInfo.second = CharUnits::fromQuantity(
1872                 getTypeStackAlignInBytes(Ty, TypeInfo.second.getQuantity()));
1873 
1874   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false,
1875                           TypeInfo, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4),
1876                           /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true);
1877 }
1878 
1879 bool X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI(
1880     const llvm::Triple &Triple, const CodeGenOptions &Opts) {
1881   assert(Triple.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86);
1882 
1883   switch (Opts.getStructReturnConvention()) {
1884   case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_Default:
1885     break;
1886   case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_OnStack:  // -fpcc-struct-return
1887     return false;
1888   case CodeGenOptions::SRCK_InRegs:  // -freg-struct-return
1889     return true;
1890   }
1891 
1892   if (Triple.isOSDarwin() || Triple.isOSIAMCU())
1893     return true;
1894 
1895   switch (Triple.getOS()) {
1896   case llvm::Triple::DragonFly:
1897   case llvm::Triple::FreeBSD:
1898   case llvm::Triple::OpenBSD:
1899   case llvm::Triple::Bitrig:
1900   case llvm::Triple::Win32:
1901     return true;
1902   default:
1903     return false;
1904   }
1905 }
1906 
1907 void X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D,
1908                                                   llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
1909                                             CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
1910   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1911     if (FD->hasAttr<X86ForceAlignArgPointerAttr>()) {
1912       // Get the LLVM function.
1913       llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
1914 
1915       // Now add the 'alignstack' attribute with a value of 16.
1916       llvm::AttrBuilder B;
1917       B.addStackAlignmentAttr(16);
1918       Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B);
1919     }
1920     if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) {
1921       llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
1922       Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR);
1923     }
1924   }
1925 }
1926 
1927 bool X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(
1928                                                CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
1929                                                llvm::Value *Address) const {
1930   CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
1931 
1932   llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4);
1933 
1934   // 0-7 are the eight integer registers;  the order is different
1935   //   on Darwin (for EH), but the range is the same.
1936   // 8 is %eip.
1937   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 8);
1938 
1939   if (CGF.CGM.getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin()) {
1940     // 12-16 are st(0..4).  Not sure why we stop at 4.
1941     // These have size 16, which is sizeof(long double) on
1942     // platforms with 8-byte alignment for that type.
1943     llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 16);
1944     AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 12, 16);
1945 
1946   } else {
1947     // 9 is %eflags, which doesn't get a size on Darwin for some
1948     // reason.
1949     Builder.CreateAlignedStore(
1950         Four8, Builder.CreateConstInBoundsGEP1_32(CGF.Int8Ty, Address, 9),
1951                                CharUnits::One());
1952 
1953     // 11-16 are st(0..5).  Not sure why we stop at 5.
1954     // These have size 12, which is sizeof(long double) on
1955     // platforms with 4-byte alignment for that type.
1956     llvm::Value *Twelve8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 12);
1957     AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Twelve8, 11, 16);
1958   }
1959 
1960   return false;
1961 }
1962 
1963 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1964 // X86-64 ABI Implementation
1965 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
1966 
1967 
1968 namespace {
1969 /// The AVX ABI level for X86 targets.
1970 enum class X86AVXABILevel {
1971   None,
1972   AVX,
1973   AVX512
1974 };
1975 
1976 /// \p returns the size in bits of the largest (native) vector for \p AVXLevel.
1977 static unsigned getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) {
1978   switch (AVXLevel) {
1979   case X86AVXABILevel::AVX512:
1980     return 512;
1981   case X86AVXABILevel::AVX:
1982     return 256;
1983   case X86AVXABILevel::None:
1984     return 128;
1985   }
1986   llvm_unreachable("Unknown AVXLevel");
1987 }
1988 
1989 /// X86_64ABIInfo - The X86_64 ABI information.
1990 class X86_64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
1991   enum Class {
1992     Integer = 0,
1993     SSE,
1994     SSEUp,
1995     X87,
1996     X87Up,
1997     ComplexX87,
1998     NoClass,
1999     Memory
2000   };
2001 
2002   /// merge - Implement the X86_64 ABI merging algorithm.
2003   ///
2004   /// Merge an accumulating classification \arg Accum with a field
2005   /// classification \arg Field.
2006   ///
2007   /// \param Accum - The accumulating classification. This should
2008   /// always be either NoClass or the result of a previous merge
2009   /// call. In addition, this should never be Memory (the caller
2010   /// should just return Memory for the aggregate).
2011   static Class merge(Class Accum, Class Field);
2012 
2013   /// postMerge - Implement the X86_64 ABI post merging algorithm.
2014   ///
2015   /// Post merger cleanup, reduces a malformed Hi and Lo pair to
2016   /// final MEMORY or SSE classes when necessary.
2017   ///
2018   /// \param AggregateSize - The size of the current aggregate in
2019   /// the classification process.
2020   ///
2021   /// \param Lo - The classification for the parts of the type
2022   /// residing in the low word of the containing object.
2023   ///
2024   /// \param Hi - The classification for the parts of the type
2025   /// residing in the higher words of the containing object.
2026   ///
2027   void postMerge(unsigned AggregateSize, Class &Lo, Class &Hi) const;
2028 
2029   /// classify - Determine the x86_64 register classes in which the
2030   /// given type T should be passed.
2031   ///
2032   /// \param Lo - The classification for the parts of the type
2033   /// residing in the low word of the containing object.
2034   ///
2035   /// \param Hi - The classification for the parts of the type
2036   /// residing in the high word of the containing object.
2037   ///
2038   /// \param OffsetBase - The bit offset of this type in the
2039   /// containing object.  Some parameters are classified different
2040   /// depending on whether they straddle an eightbyte boundary.
2041   ///
2042   /// \param isNamedArg - Whether the argument in question is a "named"
2043   /// argument, as used in AMD64-ABI 3.5.7.
2044   ///
2045   /// If a word is unused its result will be NoClass; if a type should
2046   /// be passed in Memory then at least the classification of \arg Lo
2047   /// will be Memory.
2048   ///
2049   /// The \arg Lo class will be NoClass iff the argument is ignored.
2050   ///
2051   /// If the \arg Lo class is ComplexX87, then the \arg Hi class will
2052   /// also be ComplexX87.
2053   void classify(QualType T, uint64_t OffsetBase, Class &Lo, Class &Hi,
2054                 bool isNamedArg) const;
2055 
2056   llvm::Type *GetByteVectorType(QualType Ty) const;
2057   llvm::Type *GetSSETypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType,
2058                                  unsigned IROffset, QualType SourceTy,
2059                                  unsigned SourceOffset) const;
2060   llvm::Type *GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType,
2061                                      unsigned IROffset, QualType SourceTy,
2062                                      unsigned SourceOffset) const;
2063 
2064   /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result
2065   /// such that the argument will be returned in memory.
2066   ABIArgInfo getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty) const;
2067 
2068   /// getIndirectResult - Give a source type \arg Ty, return a suitable result
2069   /// such that the argument will be passed in memory.
2070   ///
2071   /// \param freeIntRegs - The number of free integer registers remaining
2072   /// available.
2073   ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs) const;
2074 
2075   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
2076 
2077   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs,
2078                                   unsigned &neededInt, unsigned &neededSSE,
2079                                   bool isNamedArg) const;
2080 
2081   ABIArgInfo classifyRegCallStructType(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt,
2082                                        unsigned &NeededSSE) const;
2083 
2084   ABIArgInfo classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt,
2085                                            unsigned &NeededSSE) const;
2086 
2087   bool IsIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const;
2088 
2089   /// The 0.98 ABI revision clarified a lot of ambiguities,
2090   /// unfortunately in ways that were not always consistent with
2091   /// certain previous compilers.  In particular, platforms which
2092   /// required strict binary compatibility with older versions of GCC
2093   /// may need to exempt themselves.
2094   bool honorsRevision0_98() const {
2095     return !getTarget().getTriple().isOSDarwin();
2096   }
2097 
2098   /// GCC classifies <1 x long long> as SSE but compatibility with older clang
2099   // compilers require us to classify it as INTEGER.
2100   bool classifyIntegerMMXAsSSE() const {
2101     const llvm::Triple &Triple = getTarget().getTriple();
2102     if (Triple.isOSDarwin() || Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::PS4)
2103       return false;
2104     if (Triple.isOSFreeBSD() && Triple.getOSMajorVersion() >= 10)
2105       return false;
2106     return true;
2107   }
2108 
2109   X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel;
2110   // Some ABIs (e.g. X32 ABI and Native Client OS) use 32 bit pointers on
2111   // 64-bit hardware.
2112   bool Has64BitPointers;
2113 
2114 public:
2115   X86_64ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel) :
2116       SwiftABIInfo(CGT), AVXLevel(AVXLevel),
2117       Has64BitPointers(CGT.getDataLayout().getPointerSize(0) == 8) {
2118   }
2119 
2120   bool isPassedUsingAVXType(QualType type) const {
2121     unsigned neededInt, neededSSE;
2122     // The freeIntRegs argument doesn't matter here.
2123     ABIArgInfo info = classifyArgumentType(type, 0, neededInt, neededSSE,
2124                                            /*isNamedArg*/true);
2125     if (info.isDirect()) {
2126       llvm::Type *ty = info.getCoerceToType();
2127       if (llvm::VectorType *vectorTy = dyn_cast_or_null<llvm::VectorType>(ty))
2128         return (vectorTy->getBitWidth() > 128);
2129     }
2130     return false;
2131   }
2132 
2133   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
2134 
2135   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
2136                     QualType Ty) const override;
2137   Address EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
2138                       QualType Ty) const override;
2139 
2140   bool has64BitPointers() const {
2141     return Has64BitPointers;
2142   }
2143 
2144   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize,
2145                                     ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
2146                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
2147     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
2148   }
2149   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
2150     return true;
2151   }
2152 };
2153 
2154 /// WinX86_64ABIInfo - The Windows X86_64 ABI information.
2155 class WinX86_64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
2156 public:
2157   WinX86_64ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
2158       : SwiftABIInfo(CGT),
2159         IsMingw64(getTarget().getTriple().isWindowsGNUEnvironment()) {}
2160 
2161   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
2162 
2163   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
2164                     QualType Ty) const override;
2165 
2166   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override {
2167     // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use.
2168     return isX86VectorTypeForVectorCall(getContext(), Ty);
2169   }
2170 
2171   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty,
2172                                          uint64_t NumMembers) const override {
2173     // FIXME: Assumes vectorcall is in use.
2174     return isX86VectorCallAggregateSmallEnough(NumMembers);
2175   }
2176 
2177   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize,
2178                                     ArrayRef<llvm::Type *> scalars,
2179                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
2180     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
2181   }
2182 
2183   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
2184     return true;
2185   }
2186 
2187 private:
2188   ABIArgInfo classify(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs, bool IsReturnType,
2189                       bool IsVectorCall, bool IsRegCall) const;
2190   ABIArgInfo reclassifyHvaArgType(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs,
2191                                       const ABIArgInfo &current) const;
2192   void computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI, unsigned FreeSSERegs,
2193                              bool IsVectorCall, bool IsRegCall) const;
2194 
2195     bool IsMingw64;
2196 };
2197 
2198 class X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
2199 public:
2200   X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel)
2201       : TargetCodeGenInfo(new X86_64ABIInfo(CGT, AVXLevel)) {}
2202 
2203   const X86_64ABIInfo &getABIInfo() const {
2204     return static_cast<const X86_64ABIInfo&>(TargetCodeGenInfo::getABIInfo());
2205   }
2206 
2207   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
2208     return 7;
2209   }
2210 
2211   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
2212                                llvm::Value *Address) const override {
2213     llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 8);
2214 
2215     // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers.
2216     // 16 is %rip.
2217     AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 16);
2218     return false;
2219   }
2220 
2221   llvm::Type* adjustInlineAsmType(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
2222                                   StringRef Constraint,
2223                                   llvm::Type* Ty) const override {
2224     return X86AdjustInlineAsmType(CGF, Constraint, Ty);
2225   }
2226 
2227   bool isNoProtoCallVariadic(const CallArgList &args,
2228                              const FunctionNoProtoType *fnType) const override {
2229     // The default CC on x86-64 sets %al to the number of SSA
2230     // registers used, and GCC sets this when calling an unprototyped
2231     // function, so we override the default behavior.  However, don't do
2232     // that when AVX types are involved: the ABI explicitly states it is
2233     // undefined, and it doesn't work in practice because of how the ABI
2234     // defines varargs anyway.
2235     if (fnType->getCallConv() == CC_C) {
2236       bool HasAVXType = false;
2237       for (CallArgList::const_iterator
2238              it = args.begin(), ie = args.end(); it != ie; ++it) {
2239         if (getABIInfo().isPassedUsingAVXType(it->Ty)) {
2240           HasAVXType = true;
2241           break;
2242         }
2243       }
2244 
2245       if (!HasAVXType)
2246         return true;
2247     }
2248 
2249     return TargetCodeGenInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic(args, fnType);
2250   }
2251 
2252   llvm::Constant *
2253   getUBSanFunctionSignature(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
2254     unsigned Sig;
2255     if (getABIInfo().has64BitPointers())
2256       Sig = (0xeb << 0) |  // jmp rel8
2257             (0x0a << 8) |  //           .+0x0c
2258             ('F' << 16) |
2259             ('T' << 24);
2260     else
2261       Sig = (0xeb << 0) |  // jmp rel8
2262             (0x06 << 8) |  //           .+0x08
2263             ('F' << 16) |
2264             ('T' << 24);
2265     return llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGM.Int32Ty, Sig);
2266   }
2267 
2268   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
2269                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
2270     if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2271       if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) {
2272         llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
2273         Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR);
2274       }
2275     }
2276   }
2277 };
2278 
2279 class PS4TargetCodeGenInfo : public X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo {
2280 public:
2281   PS4TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel)
2282     : X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, AVXLevel) {}
2283 
2284   void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib,
2285                                  llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override {
2286     Opt = "\01";
2287     // If the argument contains a space, enclose it in quotes.
2288     if (Lib.find(" ") != StringRef::npos)
2289       Opt += "\"" + Lib.str() + "\"";
2290     else
2291       Opt += Lib;
2292   }
2293 };
2294 
2295 static std::string qualifyWindowsLibrary(llvm::StringRef Lib) {
2296   // If the argument does not end in .lib, automatically add the suffix.
2297   // If the argument contains a space, enclose it in quotes.
2298   // This matches the behavior of MSVC.
2299   bool Quote = (Lib.find(" ") != StringRef::npos);
2300   std::string ArgStr = Quote ? "\"" : "";
2301   ArgStr += Lib;
2302   if (!Lib.endswith_lower(".lib"))
2303     ArgStr += ".lib";
2304   ArgStr += Quote ? "\"" : "";
2305   return ArgStr;
2306 }
2307 
2308 class WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo : public X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo {
2309 public:
2310   WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT,
2311         bool DarwinVectorABI, bool RetSmallStructInRegABI, bool Win32StructABI,
2312         unsigned NumRegisterParameters)
2313     : X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, DarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI,
2314         Win32StructABI, NumRegisterParameters, false) {}
2315 
2316   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
2317                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override;
2318 
2319   void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib,
2320                                  llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override {
2321     Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:";
2322     Opt += qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib);
2323   }
2324 
2325   void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name,
2326                                llvm::StringRef Value,
2327                                llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override {
2328     Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\"";
2329   }
2330 };
2331 
2332 static void addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(const Decl *D,
2333                                              llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
2334                                              CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) {
2335   if (D && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2336     if (CGM.getCodeGenOpts().StackProbeSize != 4096) {
2337       llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
2338 
2339       Fn->addFnAttr("stack-probe-size",
2340                     llvm::utostr(CGM.getCodeGenOpts().StackProbeSize));
2341     }
2342   }
2343 }
2344 
2345 void WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D,
2346                                                      llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
2347                                             CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
2348   X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
2349 
2350   addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(D, GV, CGM);
2351 }
2352 
2353 class WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
2354 public:
2355   WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT,
2356                              X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel)
2357       : TargetCodeGenInfo(new WinX86_64ABIInfo(CGT)) {}
2358 
2359   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
2360                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override;
2361 
2362   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
2363     return 7;
2364   }
2365 
2366   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
2367                                llvm::Value *Address) const override {
2368     llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 8);
2369 
2370     // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers.
2371     // 16 is %rip.
2372     AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 16);
2373     return false;
2374   }
2375 
2376   void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib,
2377                                  llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override {
2378     Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:";
2379     Opt += qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib);
2380   }
2381 
2382   void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name,
2383                                llvm::StringRef Value,
2384                                llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override {
2385     Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\"";
2386   }
2387 };
2388 
2389 void WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D,
2390                                                      llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
2391                                             CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
2392   TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
2393 
2394   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2395     if (FD->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) {
2396       llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
2397       Fn->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::X86_INTR);
2398     }
2399   }
2400 
2401   addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(D, GV, CGM);
2402 }
2403 }
2404 
2405 void X86_64ABIInfo::postMerge(unsigned AggregateSize, Class &Lo,
2406                               Class &Hi) const {
2407   // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 5. Then a post merger cleanup is done:
2408   //
2409   // (a) If one of the classes is Memory, the whole argument is passed in
2410   //     memory.
2411   //
2412   // (b) If X87UP is not preceded by X87, the whole argument is passed in
2413   //     memory.
2414   //
2415   // (c) If the size of the aggregate exceeds two eightbytes and the first
2416   //     eightbyte isn't SSE or any other eightbyte isn't SSEUP, the whole
2417   //     argument is passed in memory. NOTE: This is necessary to keep the
2418   //     ABI working for processors that don't support the __m256 type.
2419   //
2420   // (d) If SSEUP is not preceded by SSE or SSEUP, it is converted to SSE.
2421   //
2422   // Some of these are enforced by the merging logic.  Others can arise
2423   // only with unions; for example:
2424   //   union { _Complex double; unsigned; }
2425   //
2426   // Note that clauses (b) and (c) were added in 0.98.
2427   //
2428   if (Hi == Memory)
2429     Lo = Memory;
2430   if (Hi == X87Up && Lo != X87 && honorsRevision0_98())
2431     Lo = Memory;
2432   if (AggregateSize > 128 && (Lo != SSE || Hi != SSEUp))
2433     Lo = Memory;
2434   if (Hi == SSEUp && Lo != SSE)
2435     Hi = SSE;
2436 }
2437 
2438 X86_64ABIInfo::Class X86_64ABIInfo::merge(Class Accum, Class Field) {
2439   // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 4. Each field of an object is
2440   // classified recursively so that always two fields are
2441   // considered. The resulting class is calculated according to
2442   // the classes of the fields in the eightbyte:
2443   //
2444   // (a) If both classes are equal, this is the resulting class.
2445   //
2446   // (b) If one of the classes is NO_CLASS, the resulting class is
2447   // the other class.
2448   //
2449   // (c) If one of the classes is MEMORY, the result is the MEMORY
2450   // class.
2451   //
2452   // (d) If one of the classes is INTEGER, the result is the
2453   // INTEGER.
2454   //
2455   // (e) If one of the classes is X87, X87UP, COMPLEX_X87 class,
2456   // MEMORY is used as class.
2457   //
2458   // (f) Otherwise class SSE is used.
2459 
2460   // Accum should never be memory (we should have returned) or
2461   // ComplexX87 (because this cannot be passed in a structure).
2462   assert((Accum != Memory && Accum != ComplexX87) &&
2463          "Invalid accumulated classification during merge.");
2464   if (Accum == Field || Field == NoClass)
2465     return Accum;
2466   if (Field == Memory)
2467     return Memory;
2468   if (Accum == NoClass)
2469     return Field;
2470   if (Accum == Integer || Field == Integer)
2471     return Integer;
2472   if (Field == X87 || Field == X87Up || Field == ComplexX87 ||
2473       Accum == X87 || Accum == X87Up)
2474     return Memory;
2475   return SSE;
2476 }
2477 
2478 void X86_64ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty, uint64_t OffsetBase,
2479                              Class &Lo, Class &Hi, bool isNamedArg) const {
2480   // FIXME: This code can be simplified by introducing a simple value class for
2481   // Class pairs with appropriate constructor methods for the various
2482   // situations.
2483 
2484   // FIXME: Some of the split computations are wrong; unaligned vectors
2485   // shouldn't be passed in registers for example, so there is no chance they
2486   // can straddle an eightbyte. Verify & simplify.
2487 
2488   Lo = Hi = NoClass;
2489 
2490   Class &Current = OffsetBase < 64 ? Lo : Hi;
2491   Current = Memory;
2492 
2493   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
2494     BuiltinType::Kind k = BT->getKind();
2495 
2496     if (k == BuiltinType::Void) {
2497       Current = NoClass;
2498     } else if (k == BuiltinType::Int128 || k == BuiltinType::UInt128) {
2499       Lo = Integer;
2500       Hi = Integer;
2501     } else if (k >= BuiltinType::Bool && k <= BuiltinType::LongLong) {
2502       Current = Integer;
2503     } else if (k == BuiltinType::Float || k == BuiltinType::Double) {
2504       Current = SSE;
2505     } else if (k == BuiltinType::LongDouble) {
2506       const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat();
2507       if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad()) {
2508         Lo = SSE;
2509         Hi = SSEUp;
2510       } else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended()) {
2511         Lo = X87;
2512         Hi = X87Up;
2513       } else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble()) {
2514         Current = SSE;
2515       } else
2516         llvm_unreachable("unexpected long double representation!");
2517     }
2518     // FIXME: _Decimal32 and _Decimal64 are SSE.
2519     // FIXME: _float128 and _Decimal128 are (SSE, SSEUp).
2520     return;
2521   }
2522 
2523   if (const EnumType *ET = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) {
2524     // Classify the underlying integer type.
2525     classify(ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType(), OffsetBase, Lo, Hi, isNamedArg);
2526     return;
2527   }
2528 
2529   if (Ty->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
2530     Current = Integer;
2531     return;
2532   }
2533 
2534   if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
2535     if (Ty->isMemberFunctionPointerType()) {
2536       if (Has64BitPointers) {
2537         // If Has64BitPointers, this is an {i64, i64}, so classify both
2538         // Lo and Hi now.
2539         Lo = Hi = Integer;
2540       } else {
2541         // Otherwise, with 32-bit pointers, this is an {i32, i32}. If that
2542         // straddles an eightbyte boundary, Hi should be classified as well.
2543         uint64_t EB_FuncPtr = (OffsetBase) / 64;
2544         uint64_t EB_ThisAdj = (OffsetBase + 64 - 1) / 64;
2545         if (EB_FuncPtr != EB_ThisAdj) {
2546           Lo = Hi = Integer;
2547         } else {
2548           Current = Integer;
2549         }
2550       }
2551     } else {
2552       Current = Integer;
2553     }
2554     return;
2555   }
2556 
2557   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
2558     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
2559     if (Size == 1 || Size == 8 || Size == 16 || Size == 32) {
2560       // gcc passes the following as integer:
2561       // 4 bytes - <4 x char>, <2 x short>, <1 x int>, <1 x float>
2562       // 2 bytes - <2 x char>, <1 x short>
2563       // 1 byte  - <1 x char>
2564       Current = Integer;
2565 
2566       // If this type crosses an eightbyte boundary, it should be
2567       // split.
2568       uint64_t EB_Lo = (OffsetBase) / 64;
2569       uint64_t EB_Hi = (OffsetBase + Size - 1) / 64;
2570       if (EB_Lo != EB_Hi)
2571         Hi = Lo;
2572     } else if (Size == 64) {
2573       QualType ElementType = VT->getElementType();
2574 
2575       // gcc passes <1 x double> in memory. :(
2576       if (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double))
2577         return;
2578 
2579       // gcc passes <1 x long long> as SSE but clang used to unconditionally
2580       // pass them as integer.  For platforms where clang is the de facto
2581       // platform compiler, we must continue to use integer.
2582       if (!classifyIntegerMMXAsSSE() &&
2583           (ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::LongLong) ||
2584            ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULongLong) ||
2585            ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Long) ||
2586            ElementType->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::ULong)))
2587         Current = Integer;
2588       else
2589         Current = SSE;
2590 
2591       // If this type crosses an eightbyte boundary, it should be
2592       // split.
2593       if (OffsetBase && OffsetBase != 64)
2594         Hi = Lo;
2595     } else if (Size == 128 ||
2596                (isNamedArg && Size <= getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) {
2597       // Arguments of 256-bits are split into four eightbyte chunks. The
2598       // least significant one belongs to class SSE and all the others to class
2599       // SSEUP. The original Lo and Hi design considers that types can't be
2600       // greater than 128-bits, so a 64-bit split in Hi and Lo makes sense.
2601       // This design isn't correct for 256-bits, but since there're no cases
2602       // where the upper parts would need to be inspected, avoid adding
2603       // complexity and just consider Hi to match the 64-256 part.
2604       //
2605       // Note that per 3.5.7 of AMD64-ABI, 256-bit args are only passed in
2606       // registers if they are "named", i.e. not part of the "..." of a
2607       // variadic function.
2608       //
2609       // Similarly, per 3.2.3. of the AVX512 draft, 512-bits ("named") args are
2610       // split into eight eightbyte chunks, one SSE and seven SSEUP.
2611       Lo = SSE;
2612       Hi = SSEUp;
2613     }
2614     return;
2615   }
2616 
2617   if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) {
2618     QualType ET = getContext().getCanonicalType(CT->getElementType());
2619 
2620     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
2621     if (ET->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
2622       if (Size <= 64)
2623         Current = Integer;
2624       else if (Size <= 128)
2625         Lo = Hi = Integer;
2626     } else if (ET == getContext().FloatTy) {
2627       Current = SSE;
2628     } else if (ET == getContext().DoubleTy) {
2629       Lo = Hi = SSE;
2630     } else if (ET == getContext().LongDoubleTy) {
2631       const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat();
2632       if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEquad())
2633         Current = Memory;
2634       else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended())
2635         Current = ComplexX87;
2636       else if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::IEEEdouble())
2637         Lo = Hi = SSE;
2638       else
2639         llvm_unreachable("unexpected long double representation!");
2640     }
2641 
2642     // If this complex type crosses an eightbyte boundary then it
2643     // should be split.
2644     uint64_t EB_Real = (OffsetBase) / 64;
2645     uint64_t EB_Imag = (OffsetBase + getContext().getTypeSize(ET)) / 64;
2646     if (Hi == NoClass && EB_Real != EB_Imag)
2647       Hi = Lo;
2648 
2649     return;
2650   }
2651 
2652   if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) {
2653     // Arrays are treated like structures.
2654 
2655     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
2656 
2657     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger
2658     // than eight eightbytes, ..., it has class MEMORY.
2659     if (Size > 512)
2660       return;
2661 
2662     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If ..., or it contains unaligned
2663     // fields, it has class MEMORY.
2664     //
2665     // Only need to check alignment of array base.
2666     if (OffsetBase % getContext().getTypeAlign(AT->getElementType()))
2667       return;
2668 
2669     // Otherwise implement simplified merge. We could be smarter about
2670     // this, but it isn't worth it and would be harder to verify.
2671     Current = NoClass;
2672     uint64_t EltSize = getContext().getTypeSize(AT->getElementType());
2673     uint64_t ArraySize = AT->getSize().getZExtValue();
2674 
2675     // The only case a 256-bit wide vector could be used is when the array
2676     // contains a single 256-bit element. Since Lo and Hi logic isn't extended
2677     // to work for sizes wider than 128, early check and fallback to memory.
2678     //
2679     if (Size > 128 &&
2680         (Size != EltSize || Size > getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel)))
2681       return;
2682 
2683     for (uint64_t i=0, Offset=OffsetBase; i<ArraySize; ++i, Offset += EltSize) {
2684       Class FieldLo, FieldHi;
2685       classify(AT->getElementType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg);
2686       Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo);
2687       Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi);
2688       if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory)
2689         break;
2690     }
2691 
2692     postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi);
2693     assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp array classification.");
2694     return;
2695   }
2696 
2697   if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
2698     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
2699 
2700     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger
2701     // than eight eightbytes, ..., it has class MEMORY.
2702     if (Size > 512)
2703       return;
2704 
2705     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 2. If a C++ object has either a non-trivial
2706     // copy constructor or a non-trivial destructor, it is passed by invisible
2707     // reference.
2708     if (getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()))
2709       return;
2710 
2711     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
2712 
2713     // Assume variable sized types are passed in memory.
2714     if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
2715       return;
2716 
2717     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2718 
2719     // Reset Lo class, this will be recomputed.
2720     Current = NoClass;
2721 
2722     // If this is a C++ record, classify the bases first.
2723     if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
2724       for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) {
2725         assert(!I.isVirtual() && !I.getType()->isDependentType() &&
2726                "Unexpected base class!");
2727         const CXXRecordDecl *Base =
2728           cast<CXXRecordDecl>(I.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
2729 
2730         // Classify this field.
2731         //
2732         // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 3. If the size of the aggregate exceeds a
2733         // single eightbyte, each is classified separately. Each eightbyte gets
2734         // initialized to class NO_CLASS.
2735         Class FieldLo, FieldHi;
2736         uint64_t Offset =
2737           OffsetBase + getContext().toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base));
2738         classify(I.getType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg);
2739         Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo);
2740         Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi);
2741         if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory) {
2742           postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi);
2743           return;
2744         }
2745       }
2746     }
2747 
2748     // Classify the fields one at a time, merging the results.
2749     unsigned idx = 0;
2750     for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end();
2751            i != e; ++i, ++idx) {
2752       uint64_t Offset = OffsetBase + Layout.getFieldOffset(idx);
2753       bool BitField = i->isBitField();
2754 
2755       // Ignore padding bit-fields.
2756       if (BitField && i->isUnnamedBitfield())
2757         continue;
2758 
2759       // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 1. If the size of an object is larger than
2760       // four eightbytes, or it contains unaligned fields, it has class MEMORY.
2761       //
2762       // The only case a 256-bit wide vector could be used is when the struct
2763       // contains a single 256-bit element. Since Lo and Hi logic isn't extended
2764       // to work for sizes wider than 128, early check and fallback to memory.
2765       //
2766       if (Size > 128 && (Size != getContext().getTypeSize(i->getType()) ||
2767                          Size > getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel))) {
2768         Lo = Memory;
2769         postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi);
2770         return;
2771       }
2772       // Note, skip this test for bit-fields, see below.
2773       if (!BitField && Offset % getContext().getTypeAlign(i->getType())) {
2774         Lo = Memory;
2775         postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi);
2776         return;
2777       }
2778 
2779       // Classify this field.
2780       //
2781       // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p2: Rule 3. If the size of the aggregate
2782       // exceeds a single eightbyte, each is classified
2783       // separately. Each eightbyte gets initialized to class
2784       // NO_CLASS.
2785       Class FieldLo, FieldHi;
2786 
2787       // Bit-fields require special handling, they do not force the
2788       // structure to be passed in memory even if unaligned, and
2789       // therefore they can straddle an eightbyte.
2790       if (BitField) {
2791         assert(!i->isUnnamedBitfield());
2792         uint64_t Offset = OffsetBase + Layout.getFieldOffset(idx);
2793         uint64_t Size = i->getBitWidthValue(getContext());
2794 
2795         uint64_t EB_Lo = Offset / 64;
2796         uint64_t EB_Hi = (Offset + Size - 1) / 64;
2797 
2798         if (EB_Lo) {
2799           assert(EB_Hi == EB_Lo && "Invalid classification, type > 16 bytes.");
2800           FieldLo = NoClass;
2801           FieldHi = Integer;
2802         } else {
2803           FieldLo = Integer;
2804           FieldHi = EB_Hi ? Integer : NoClass;
2805         }
2806       } else
2807         classify(i->getType(), Offset, FieldLo, FieldHi, isNamedArg);
2808       Lo = merge(Lo, FieldLo);
2809       Hi = merge(Hi, FieldHi);
2810       if (Lo == Memory || Hi == Memory)
2811         break;
2812     }
2813 
2814     postMerge(Size, Lo, Hi);
2815   }
2816 }
2817 
2818 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::getIndirectReturnResult(QualType Ty) const {
2819   // If this is a scalar LLVM value then assume LLVM will pass it in the right
2820   // place naturally.
2821   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
2822     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
2823     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
2824       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
2825 
2826     return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
2827             ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
2828   }
2829 
2830   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty);
2831 }
2832 
2833 bool X86_64ABIInfo::IsIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const {
2834   if (const VectorType *VecTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
2835     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VecTy);
2836     unsigned LargestVector = getNativeVectorSizeForAVXABI(AVXLevel);
2837     if (Size <= 64 || Size > LargestVector)
2838       return true;
2839   }
2840 
2841   return false;
2842 }
2843 
2844 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty,
2845                                             unsigned freeIntRegs) const {
2846   // If this is a scalar LLVM value then assume LLVM will pass it in the right
2847   // place naturally.
2848   //
2849   // This assumption is optimistic, as there could be free registers available
2850   // when we need to pass this argument in memory, and LLVM could try to pass
2851   // the argument in the free register. This does not seem to happen currently,
2852   // but this code would be much safer if we could mark the argument with
2853   // 'onstack'. See PR12193.
2854   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !IsIllegalVectorType(Ty)) {
2855     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
2856     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
2857       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
2858 
2859     return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
2860             ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
2861   }
2862 
2863   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
2864     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
2865 
2866   // Compute the byval alignment. We specify the alignment of the byval in all
2867   // cases so that the mid-level optimizer knows the alignment of the byval.
2868   unsigned Align = std::max(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8, 8U);
2869 
2870   // Attempt to avoid passing indirect results using byval when possible. This
2871   // is important for good codegen.
2872   //
2873   // We do this by coercing the value into a scalar type which the backend can
2874   // handle naturally (i.e., without using byval).
2875   //
2876   // For simplicity, we currently only do this when we have exhausted all of the
2877   // free integer registers. Doing this when there are free integer registers
2878   // would require more care, as we would have to ensure that the coerced value
2879   // did not claim the unused register. That would require either reording the
2880   // arguments to the function (so that any subsequent inreg values came first),
2881   // or only doing this optimization when there were no following arguments that
2882   // might be inreg.
2883   //
2884   // We currently expect it to be rare (particularly in well written code) for
2885   // arguments to be passed on the stack when there are still free integer
2886   // registers available (this would typically imply large structs being passed
2887   // by value), so this seems like a fair tradeoff for now.
2888   //
2889   // We can revisit this if the backend grows support for 'onstack' parameter
2890   // attributes. See PR12193.
2891   if (freeIntRegs == 0) {
2892     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
2893 
2894     // If this type fits in an eightbyte, coerce it into the matching integral
2895     // type, which will end up on the stack (with alignment 8).
2896     if (Align == 8 && Size <= 64)
2897       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),
2898                                                           Size));
2899   }
2900 
2901   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align));
2902 }
2903 
2904 /// The ABI specifies that a value should be passed in a full vector XMM/YMM
2905 /// register. Pick an LLVM IR type that will be passed as a vector register.
2906 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo::GetByteVectorType(QualType Ty) const {
2907   // Wrapper structs/arrays that only contain vectors are passed just like
2908   // vectors; strip them off if present.
2909   if (const Type *InnerTy = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext()))
2910     Ty = QualType(InnerTy, 0);
2911 
2912   llvm::Type *IRType = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
2913   if (isa<llvm::VectorType>(IRType) ||
2914       IRType->getTypeID() == llvm::Type::FP128TyID)
2915     return IRType;
2916 
2917   // We couldn't find the preferred IR vector type for 'Ty'.
2918   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
2919   assert((Size == 128 || Size == 256 || Size == 512) && "Invalid type found!");
2920 
2921   // Return a LLVM IR vector type based on the size of 'Ty'.
2922   return llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()),
2923                                Size / 64);
2924 }
2925 
2926 /// BitsContainNoUserData - Return true if the specified [start,end) bit range
2927 /// is known to either be off the end of the specified type or being in
2928 /// alignment padding.  The user type specified is known to be at most 128 bits
2929 /// in size, and have passed through X86_64ABIInfo::classify with a successful
2930 /// classification that put one of the two halves in the INTEGER class.
2931 ///
2932 /// It is conservatively correct to return false.
2933 static bool BitsContainNoUserData(QualType Ty, unsigned StartBit,
2934                                   unsigned EndBit, ASTContext &Context) {
2935   // If the bytes being queried are off the end of the type, there is no user
2936   // data hiding here.  This handles analysis of builtins, vectors and other
2937   // types that don't contain interesting padding.
2938   unsigned TySize = (unsigned)Context.getTypeSize(Ty);
2939   if (TySize <= StartBit)
2940     return true;
2941 
2942   if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = Context.getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) {
2943     unsigned EltSize = (unsigned)Context.getTypeSize(AT->getElementType());
2944     unsigned NumElts = (unsigned)AT->getSize().getZExtValue();
2945 
2946     // Check each element to see if the element overlaps with the queried range.
2947     for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
2948       // If the element is after the span we care about, then we're done..
2949       unsigned EltOffset = i*EltSize;
2950       if (EltOffset >= EndBit) break;
2951 
2952       unsigned EltStart = EltOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-EltOffset :0;
2953       if (!BitsContainNoUserData(AT->getElementType(), EltStart,
2954                                  EndBit-EltOffset, Context))
2955         return false;
2956     }
2957     // If it overlaps no elements, then it is safe to process as padding.
2958     return true;
2959   }
2960 
2961   if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
2962     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
2963     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD);
2964 
2965     // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
2966     if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
2967       for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) {
2968         assert(!I.isVirtual() && !I.getType()->isDependentType() &&
2969                "Unexpected base class!");
2970         const CXXRecordDecl *Base =
2971           cast<CXXRecordDecl>(I.getType()->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
2972 
2973         // If the base is after the span we care about, ignore it.
2974         unsigned BaseOffset = Context.toBits(Layout.getBaseClassOffset(Base));
2975         if (BaseOffset >= EndBit) continue;
2976 
2977         unsigned BaseStart = BaseOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-BaseOffset :0;
2978         if (!BitsContainNoUserData(I.getType(), BaseStart,
2979                                    EndBit-BaseOffset, Context))
2980           return false;
2981       }
2982     }
2983 
2984     // Verify that no field has data that overlaps the region of interest.  Yes
2985     // this could be sped up a lot by being smarter about queried fields,
2986     // however we're only looking at structs up to 16 bytes, so we don't care
2987     // much.
2988     unsigned idx = 0;
2989     for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end();
2990          i != e; ++i, ++idx) {
2991       unsigned FieldOffset = (unsigned)Layout.getFieldOffset(idx);
2992 
2993       // If we found a field after the region we care about, then we're done.
2994       if (FieldOffset >= EndBit) break;
2995 
2996       unsigned FieldStart = FieldOffset < StartBit ? StartBit-FieldOffset :0;
2997       if (!BitsContainNoUserData(i->getType(), FieldStart, EndBit-FieldOffset,
2998                                  Context))
2999         return false;
3000     }
3001 
3002     // If nothing in this record overlapped the area of interest, then we're
3003     // clean.
3004     return true;
3005   }
3006 
3007   return false;
3008 }
3009 
3010 /// ContainsFloatAtOffset - Return true if the specified LLVM IR type has a
3011 /// float member at the specified offset.  For example, {int,{float}} has a
3012 /// float at offset 4.  It is conservatively correct for this routine to return
3013 /// false.
3014 static bool ContainsFloatAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset,
3015                                   const llvm::DataLayout &TD) {
3016   // Base case if we find a float.
3017   if (IROffset == 0 && IRType->isFloatTy())
3018     return true;
3019 
3020   // If this is a struct, recurse into the field at the specified offset.
3021   if (llvm::StructType *STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(IRType)) {
3022     const llvm::StructLayout *SL = TD.getStructLayout(STy);
3023     unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(IROffset);
3024     IROffset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
3025     return ContainsFloatAtOffset(STy->getElementType(Elt), IROffset, TD);
3026   }
3027 
3028   // If this is an array, recurse into the field at the specified offset.
3029   if (llvm::ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(IRType)) {
3030     llvm::Type *EltTy = ATy->getElementType();
3031     unsigned EltSize = TD.getTypeAllocSize(EltTy);
3032     IROffset -= IROffset/EltSize*EltSize;
3033     return ContainsFloatAtOffset(EltTy, IROffset, TD);
3034   }
3035 
3036   return false;
3037 }
3038 
3039 
3040 /// GetSSETypeAtOffset - Return a type that will be passed by the backend in the
3041 /// low 8 bytes of an XMM register, corresponding to the SSE class.
3042 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo::
3043 GetSSETypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset,
3044                    QualType SourceTy, unsigned SourceOffset) const {
3045   // The only three choices we have are either double, <2 x float>, or float. We
3046   // pass as float if the last 4 bytes is just padding.  This happens for
3047   // structs that contain 3 floats.
3048   if (BitsContainNoUserData(SourceTy, SourceOffset*8+32,
3049                             SourceOffset*8+64, getContext()))
3050     return llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext());
3051 
3052   // We want to pass as <2 x float> if the LLVM IR type contains a float at
3053   // offset+0 and offset+4.  Walk the LLVM IR type to find out if this is the
3054   // case.
3055   if (ContainsFloatAtOffset(IRType, IROffset, getDataLayout()) &&
3056       ContainsFloatAtOffset(IRType, IROffset+4, getDataLayout()))
3057     return llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()), 2);
3058 
3059   return llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext());
3060 }
3061 
3062 
3063 /// GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset - The ABI specifies that a value should be passed in
3064 /// an 8-byte GPR.  This means that we either have a scalar or we are talking
3065 /// about the high or low part of an up-to-16-byte struct.  This routine picks
3066 /// the best LLVM IR type to represent this, which may be i64 or may be anything
3067 /// else that the backend will pass in a GPR that works better (e.g. i8, %foo*,
3068 /// etc).
3069 ///
3070 /// PrefType is an LLVM IR type that corresponds to (part of) the IR type for
3071 /// the source type.  IROffset is an offset in bytes into the LLVM IR type that
3072 /// the 8-byte value references.  PrefType may be null.
3073 ///
3074 /// SourceTy is the source-level type for the entire argument.  SourceOffset is
3075 /// an offset into this that we're processing (which is always either 0 or 8).
3076 ///
3077 llvm::Type *X86_64ABIInfo::
3078 GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(llvm::Type *IRType, unsigned IROffset,
3079                        QualType SourceTy, unsigned SourceOffset) const {
3080   // If we're dealing with an un-offset LLVM IR type, then it means that we're
3081   // returning an 8-byte unit starting with it.  See if we can safely use it.
3082   if (IROffset == 0) {
3083     // Pointers and int64's always fill the 8-byte unit.
3084     if ((isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) && Has64BitPointers) ||
3085         IRType->isIntegerTy(64))
3086       return IRType;
3087 
3088     // If we have a 1/2/4-byte integer, we can use it only if the rest of the
3089     // goodness in the source type is just tail padding.  This is allowed to
3090     // kick in for struct {double,int} on the int, but not on
3091     // struct{double,int,int} because we wouldn't return the second int.  We
3092     // have to do this analysis on the source type because we can't depend on
3093     // unions being lowered a specific way etc.
3094     if (IRType->isIntegerTy(8) || IRType->isIntegerTy(16) ||
3095         IRType->isIntegerTy(32) ||
3096         (isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) && !Has64BitPointers)) {
3097       unsigned BitWidth = isa<llvm::PointerType>(IRType) ? 32 :
3098           cast<llvm::IntegerType>(IRType)->getBitWidth();
3099 
3100       if (BitsContainNoUserData(SourceTy, SourceOffset*8+BitWidth,
3101                                 SourceOffset*8+64, getContext()))
3102         return IRType;
3103     }
3104   }
3105 
3106   if (llvm::StructType *STy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(IRType)) {
3107     // If this is a struct, recurse into the field at the specified offset.
3108     const llvm::StructLayout *SL = getDataLayout().getStructLayout(STy);
3109     if (IROffset < SL->getSizeInBytes()) {
3110       unsigned FieldIdx = SL->getElementContainingOffset(IROffset);
3111       IROffset -= SL->getElementOffset(FieldIdx);
3112 
3113       return GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(STy->getElementType(FieldIdx), IROffset,
3114                                     SourceTy, SourceOffset);
3115     }
3116   }
3117 
3118   if (llvm::ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(IRType)) {
3119     llvm::Type *EltTy = ATy->getElementType();
3120     unsigned EltSize = getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(EltTy);
3121     unsigned EltOffset = IROffset/EltSize*EltSize;
3122     return GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(EltTy, IROffset-EltOffset, SourceTy,
3123                                   SourceOffset);
3124   }
3125 
3126   // Okay, we don't have any better idea of what to pass, so we pass this in an
3127   // integer register that isn't too big to fit the rest of the struct.
3128   unsigned TySizeInBytes =
3129     (unsigned)getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(SourceTy).getQuantity();
3130 
3131   assert(TySizeInBytes != SourceOffset && "Empty field?");
3132 
3133   // It is always safe to classify this as an integer type up to i64 that
3134   // isn't larger than the structure.
3135   return llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(),
3136                                 std::min(TySizeInBytes-SourceOffset, 8U)*8);
3137 }
3138 
3139 
3140 /// GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair - Given a high and low type that can ideally
3141 /// be used as elements of a two register pair to pass or return, return a
3142 /// first class aggregate to represent them.  For example, if the low part of
3143 /// a by-value argument should be passed as i32* and the high part as float,
3144 /// return {i32*, float}.
3145 static llvm::Type *
3146 GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(llvm::Type *Lo, llvm::Type *Hi,
3147                            const llvm::DataLayout &TD) {
3148   // In order to correctly satisfy the ABI, we need to the high part to start
3149   // at offset 8.  If the high and low parts we inferred are both 4-byte types
3150   // (e.g. i32 and i32) then the resultant struct type ({i32,i32}) won't have
3151   // the second element at offset 8.  Check for this:
3152   unsigned LoSize = (unsigned)TD.getTypeAllocSize(Lo);
3153   unsigned HiAlign = TD.getABITypeAlignment(Hi);
3154   unsigned HiStart = llvm::alignTo(LoSize, HiAlign);
3155   assert(HiStart != 0 && HiStart <= 8 && "Invalid x86-64 argument pair!");
3156 
3157   // To handle this, we have to increase the size of the low part so that the
3158   // second element will start at an 8 byte offset.  We can't increase the size
3159   // of the second element because it might make us access off the end of the
3160   // struct.
3161   if (HiStart != 8) {
3162     // There are usually two sorts of types the ABI generation code can produce
3163     // for the low part of a pair that aren't 8 bytes in size: float or
3164     // i8/i16/i32.  This can also include pointers when they are 32-bit (X32 and
3165     // NaCl).
3166     // Promote these to a larger type.
3167     if (Lo->isFloatTy())
3168       Lo = llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(Lo->getContext());
3169     else {
3170       assert((Lo->isIntegerTy() || Lo->isPointerTy())
3171              && "Invalid/unknown lo type");
3172       Lo = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(Lo->getContext());
3173     }
3174   }
3175 
3176   llvm::StructType *Result = llvm::StructType::get(Lo, Hi);
3177 
3178   // Verify that the second element is at an 8-byte offset.
3179   assert(TD.getStructLayout(Result)->getElementOffset(1) == 8 &&
3180          "Invalid x86-64 argument pair!");
3181   return Result;
3182 }
3183 
3184 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::
3185 classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
3186   // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 1. Classify the return type with the
3187   // classification algorithm.
3188   X86_64ABIInfo::Class Lo, Hi;
3189   classify(RetTy, 0, Lo, Hi, /*isNamedArg*/ true);
3190 
3191   // Check some invariants.
3192   assert((Hi != Memory || Lo == Memory) && "Invalid memory classification.");
3193   assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp classification.");
3194 
3195   llvm::Type *ResType = nullptr;
3196   switch (Lo) {
3197   case NoClass:
3198     if (Hi == NoClass)
3199       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
3200     // If the low part is just padding, it takes no register, leave ResType
3201     // null.
3202     assert((Hi == SSE || Hi == Integer || Hi == X87Up) &&
3203            "Unknown missing lo part");
3204     break;
3205 
3206   case SSEUp:
3207   case X87Up:
3208     llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for lo word.");
3209 
3210     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 2. Types of class memory are returned via
3211     // hidden argument.
3212   case Memory:
3213     return getIndirectReturnResult(RetTy);
3214 
3215     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 3. If the class is INTEGER, the next
3216     // available register of the sequence %rax, %rdx is used.
3217   case Integer:
3218     ResType = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 0, RetTy, 0);
3219 
3220     // If we have a sign or zero extended integer, make sure to return Extend
3221     // so that the parameter gets the right LLVM IR attributes.
3222     if (Hi == NoClass && isa<llvm::IntegerType>(ResType)) {
3223       // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
3224       if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
3225         RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
3226 
3227       if (RetTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
3228           RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
3229         return ABIArgInfo::getExtend();
3230     }
3231     break;
3232 
3233     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 4. If the class is SSE, the next
3234     // available SSE register of the sequence %xmm0, %xmm1 is used.
3235   case SSE:
3236     ResType = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 0, RetTy, 0);
3237     break;
3238 
3239     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 6. If the class is X87, the value is
3240     // returned on the X87 stack in %st0 as 80-bit x87 number.
3241   case X87:
3242     ResType = llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext());
3243     break;
3244 
3245     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 8. If the class is COMPLEX_X87, the real
3246     // part of the value is returned in %st0 and the imaginary part in
3247     // %st1.
3248   case ComplexX87:
3249     assert(Hi == ComplexX87 && "Unexpected ComplexX87 classification.");
3250     ResType = llvm::StructType::get(llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()),
3251                                     llvm::Type::getX86_FP80Ty(getVMContext()));
3252     break;
3253   }
3254 
3255   llvm::Type *HighPart = nullptr;
3256   switch (Hi) {
3257     // Memory was handled previously and X87 should
3258     // never occur as a hi class.
3259   case Memory:
3260   case X87:
3261     llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for hi word.");
3262 
3263   case ComplexX87: // Previously handled.
3264   case NoClass:
3265     break;
3266 
3267   case Integer:
3268     HighPart = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8);
3269     if (Lo == NoClass)  // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory.
3270       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8);
3271     break;
3272   case SSE:
3273     HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8);
3274     if (Lo == NoClass)  // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory.
3275       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8);
3276     break;
3277 
3278     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 5. If the class is SSEUP, the eightbyte
3279     // is passed in the next available eightbyte chunk if the last used
3280     // vector register.
3281     //
3282     // SSEUP should always be preceded by SSE, just widen.
3283   case SSEUp:
3284     assert(Lo == SSE && "Unexpected SSEUp classification.");
3285     ResType = GetByteVectorType(RetTy);
3286     break;
3287 
3288     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p4: Rule 7. If the class is X87UP, the value is
3289     // returned together with the previous X87 value in %st0.
3290   case X87Up:
3291     // If X87Up is preceded by X87, we don't need to do
3292     // anything. However, in some cases with unions it may not be
3293     // preceded by X87. In such situations we follow gcc and pass the
3294     // extra bits in an SSE reg.
3295     if (Lo != X87) {
3296       HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(RetTy), 8, RetTy, 8);
3297       if (Lo == NoClass)  // Return HighPart at offset 8 in memory.
3298         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8);
3299     }
3300     break;
3301   }
3302 
3303   // If a high part was specified, merge it together with the low part.  It is
3304   // known to pass in the high eightbyte of the result.  We do this by forming a
3305   // first class struct aggregate with the high and low part: {low, high}
3306   if (HighPart)
3307     ResType = GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(ResType, HighPart, getDataLayout());
3308 
3309   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
3310 }
3311 
3312 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(
3313   QualType Ty, unsigned freeIntRegs, unsigned &neededInt, unsigned &neededSSE,
3314   bool isNamedArg)
3315   const
3316 {
3317   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
3318 
3319   X86_64ABIInfo::Class Lo, Hi;
3320   classify(Ty, 0, Lo, Hi, isNamedArg);
3321 
3322   // Check some invariants.
3323   // FIXME: Enforce these by construction.
3324   assert((Hi != Memory || Lo == Memory) && "Invalid memory classification.");
3325   assert((Hi != SSEUp || Lo == SSE) && "Invalid SSEUp classification.");
3326 
3327   neededInt = 0;
3328   neededSSE = 0;
3329   llvm::Type *ResType = nullptr;
3330   switch (Lo) {
3331   case NoClass:
3332     if (Hi == NoClass)
3333       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
3334     // If the low part is just padding, it takes no register, leave ResType
3335     // null.
3336     assert((Hi == SSE || Hi == Integer || Hi == X87Up) &&
3337            "Unknown missing lo part");
3338     break;
3339 
3340     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 1. If the class is MEMORY, pass the argument
3341     // on the stack.
3342   case Memory:
3343 
3344     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 5. If the class is X87, X87UP or
3345     // COMPLEX_X87, it is passed in memory.
3346   case X87:
3347   case ComplexX87:
3348     if (getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()) == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect)
3349       ++neededInt;
3350     return getIndirectResult(Ty, freeIntRegs);
3351 
3352   case SSEUp:
3353   case X87Up:
3354     llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for lo word.");
3355 
3356     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 2. If the class is INTEGER, the next
3357     // available register of the sequence %rdi, %rsi, %rdx, %rcx, %r8
3358     // and %r9 is used.
3359   case Integer:
3360     ++neededInt;
3361 
3362     // Pick an 8-byte type based on the preferred type.
3363     ResType = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 0, Ty, 0);
3364 
3365     // If we have a sign or zero extended integer, make sure to return Extend
3366     // so that the parameter gets the right LLVM IR attributes.
3367     if (Hi == NoClass && isa<llvm::IntegerType>(ResType)) {
3368       // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
3369       if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
3370         Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
3371 
3372       if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
3373           Ty->isPromotableIntegerType())
3374         return ABIArgInfo::getExtend();
3375     }
3376 
3377     break;
3378 
3379     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 3. If the class is SSE, the next
3380     // available SSE register is used, the registers are taken in the
3381     // order from %xmm0 to %xmm7.
3382   case SSE: {
3383     llvm::Type *IRType = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
3384     ResType = GetSSETypeAtOffset(IRType, 0, Ty, 0);
3385     ++neededSSE;
3386     break;
3387   }
3388   }
3389 
3390   llvm::Type *HighPart = nullptr;
3391   switch (Hi) {
3392     // Memory was handled previously, ComplexX87 and X87 should
3393     // never occur as hi classes, and X87Up must be preceded by X87,
3394     // which is passed in memory.
3395   case Memory:
3396   case X87:
3397   case ComplexX87:
3398     llvm_unreachable("Invalid classification for hi word.");
3399 
3400   case NoClass: break;
3401 
3402   case Integer:
3403     ++neededInt;
3404     // Pick an 8-byte type based on the preferred type.
3405     HighPart = GetINTEGERTypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 8, Ty, 8);
3406 
3407     if (Lo == NoClass)  // Pass HighPart at offset 8 in memory.
3408       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8);
3409     break;
3410 
3411     // X87Up generally doesn't occur here (long double is passed in
3412     // memory), except in situations involving unions.
3413   case X87Up:
3414   case SSE:
3415     HighPart = GetSSETypeAtOffset(CGT.ConvertType(Ty), 8, Ty, 8);
3416 
3417     if (Lo == NoClass)  // Pass HighPart at offset 8 in memory.
3418       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HighPart, 8);
3419 
3420     ++neededSSE;
3421     break;
3422 
3423     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Rule 4. If the class is SSEUP, the
3424     // eightbyte is passed in the upper half of the last used SSE
3425     // register.  This only happens when 128-bit vectors are passed.
3426   case SSEUp:
3427     assert(Lo == SSE && "Unexpected SSEUp classification");
3428     ResType = GetByteVectorType(Ty);
3429     break;
3430   }
3431 
3432   // If a high part was specified, merge it together with the low part.  It is
3433   // known to pass in the high eightbyte of the result.  We do this by forming a
3434   // first class struct aggregate with the high and low part: {low, high}
3435   if (HighPart)
3436     ResType = GetX86_64ByValArgumentPair(ResType, HighPart, getDataLayout());
3437 
3438   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
3439 }
3440 
3441 ABIArgInfo
3442 X86_64ABIInfo::classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(QualType Ty, unsigned &NeededInt,
3443                                              unsigned &NeededSSE) const {
3444   auto RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
3445   assert(RT && "classifyRegCallStructType only valid with struct types");
3446 
3447   if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
3448     return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty);
3449 
3450   // Sum up bases
3451   if (auto CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl())) {
3452     if (CXXRD->isDynamicClass()) {
3453       NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0;
3454       return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty);
3455     }
3456 
3457     for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases())
3458       if (classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(I.getType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE)
3459               .isIndirect()) {
3460         NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0;
3461         return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty);
3462       }
3463   }
3464 
3465   // Sum up members
3466   for (const auto *FD : RT->getDecl()->fields()) {
3467     if (FD->getType()->isRecordType() && !FD->getType()->isUnionType()) {
3468       if (classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(FD->getType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE)
3469               .isIndirect()) {
3470         NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0;
3471         return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty);
3472       }
3473     } else {
3474       unsigned LocalNeededInt, LocalNeededSSE;
3475       if (classifyArgumentType(FD->getType(), UINT_MAX, LocalNeededInt,
3476                                LocalNeededSSE, true)
3477               .isIndirect()) {
3478         NeededInt = NeededSSE = 0;
3479         return getIndirectReturnResult(Ty);
3480       }
3481       NeededInt += LocalNeededInt;
3482       NeededSSE += LocalNeededSSE;
3483     }
3484   }
3485 
3486   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
3487 }
3488 
3489 ABIArgInfo X86_64ABIInfo::classifyRegCallStructType(QualType Ty,
3490                                                     unsigned &NeededInt,
3491                                                     unsigned &NeededSSE) const {
3492 
3493   NeededInt = 0;
3494   NeededSSE = 0;
3495 
3496   return classifyRegCallStructTypeImpl(Ty, NeededInt, NeededSSE);
3497 }
3498 
3499 void X86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
3500 
3501   bool IsRegCall = FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall;
3502 
3503   // Keep track of the number of assigned registers.
3504   unsigned FreeIntRegs = IsRegCall ? 11 : 6;
3505   unsigned FreeSSERegs = IsRegCall ? 16 : 8;
3506   unsigned NeededInt, NeededSSE;
3507 
3508   if (IsRegCall && FI.getReturnType()->getTypePtr()->isRecordType() &&
3509       !FI.getReturnType()->getTypePtr()->isUnionType()) {
3510     FI.getReturnInfo() =
3511         classifyRegCallStructType(FI.getReturnType(), NeededInt, NeededSSE);
3512     if (FreeIntRegs >= NeededInt && FreeSSERegs >= NeededSSE) {
3513       FreeIntRegs -= NeededInt;
3514       FreeSSERegs -= NeededSSE;
3515     } else {
3516       FI.getReturnInfo() = getIndirectReturnResult(FI.getReturnType());
3517     }
3518   } else if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
3519     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
3520 
3521   // If the return value is indirect, then the hidden argument is consuming one
3522   // integer register.
3523   if (FI.getReturnInfo().isIndirect())
3524     --FreeIntRegs;
3525 
3526   // The chain argument effectively gives us another free register.
3527   if (FI.isChainCall())
3528     ++FreeIntRegs;
3529 
3530   unsigned NumRequiredArgs = FI.getNumRequiredArgs();
3531   // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: Once arguments are classified, the registers
3532   // get assigned (in left-to-right order) for passing as follows...
3533   unsigned ArgNo = 0;
3534   for (CGFunctionInfo::arg_iterator it = FI.arg_begin(), ie = FI.arg_end();
3535        it != ie; ++it, ++ArgNo) {
3536     bool IsNamedArg = ArgNo < NumRequiredArgs;
3537 
3538     if (IsRegCall && it->type->isStructureOrClassType())
3539       it->info = classifyRegCallStructType(it->type, NeededInt, NeededSSE);
3540     else
3541       it->info = classifyArgumentType(it->type, FreeIntRegs, NeededInt,
3542                                       NeededSSE, IsNamedArg);
3543 
3544     // AMD64-ABI 3.2.3p3: If there are no registers available for any
3545     // eightbyte of an argument, the whole argument is passed on the
3546     // stack. If registers have already been assigned for some
3547     // eightbytes of such an argument, the assignments get reverted.
3548     if (FreeIntRegs >= NeededInt && FreeSSERegs >= NeededSSE) {
3549       FreeIntRegs -= NeededInt;
3550       FreeSSERegs -= NeededSSE;
3551     } else {
3552       it->info = getIndirectResult(it->type, FreeIntRegs);
3553     }
3554   }
3555 }
3556 
3557 static Address EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CodeGenFunction &CGF,
3558                                          Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty) {
3559   Address overflow_arg_area_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(
3560       VAListAddr, 2, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), "overflow_arg_area_p");
3561   llvm::Value *overflow_arg_area =
3562     CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(overflow_arg_area_p, "overflow_arg_area");
3563 
3564   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 7. Align l->overflow_arg_area upwards to a 16
3565   // byte boundary if alignment needed by type exceeds 8 byte boundary.
3566   // It isn't stated explicitly in the standard, but in practice we use
3567   // alignment greater than 16 where necessary.
3568   CharUnits Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty);
3569   if (Align > CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)) {
3570     overflow_arg_area = emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, overflow_arg_area,
3571                                                       Align);
3572   }
3573 
3574   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 8. Fetch type from l->overflow_arg_area.
3575   llvm::Type *LTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty);
3576   llvm::Value *Res =
3577     CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(overflow_arg_area,
3578                               llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(LTy));
3579 
3580   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 9. Set l->overflow_arg_area to:
3581   // l->overflow_arg_area + sizeof(type).
3582   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 10. Align l->overflow_arg_area upwards to
3583   // an 8 byte boundary.
3584 
3585   uint64_t SizeInBytes = (CGF.getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 7) / 8;
3586   llvm::Value *Offset =
3587       llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, (SizeInBytes + 7)  & ~7);
3588   overflow_arg_area = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(overflow_arg_area, Offset,
3589                                             "overflow_arg_area.next");
3590   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(overflow_arg_area, overflow_arg_area_p);
3591 
3592   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 11. Return the fetched type.
3593   return Address(Res, Align);
3594 }
3595 
3596 Address X86_64ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
3597                                  QualType Ty) const {
3598   // Assume that va_list type is correct; should be pointer to LLVM type:
3599   // struct {
3600   //   i32 gp_offset;
3601   //   i32 fp_offset;
3602   //   i8* overflow_arg_area;
3603   //   i8* reg_save_area;
3604   // };
3605   unsigned neededInt, neededSSE;
3606 
3607   Ty = getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty);
3608   ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty, 0, neededInt, neededSSE,
3609                                        /*isNamedArg*/false);
3610 
3611   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 1. Determine whether type may be passed
3612   // in the registers. If not go to step 7.
3613   if (!neededInt && !neededSSE)
3614     return EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty);
3615 
3616   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 2. Compute num_gp to hold the number of
3617   // general purpose registers needed to pass type and num_fp to hold
3618   // the number of floating point registers needed.
3619 
3620   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 3. Verify whether arguments fit into
3621   // registers. In the case: l->gp_offset > 48 - num_gp * 8 or
3622   // l->fp_offset > 304 - num_fp * 16 go to step 7.
3623   //
3624   // NOTE: 304 is a typo, there are (6 * 8 + 8 * 16) = 176 bytes of
3625   // register save space).
3626 
3627   llvm::Value *InRegs = nullptr;
3628   Address gp_offset_p = Address::invalid(), fp_offset_p = Address::invalid();
3629   llvm::Value *gp_offset = nullptr, *fp_offset = nullptr;
3630   if (neededInt) {
3631     gp_offset_p =
3632         CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 0, CharUnits::Zero(),
3633                                     "gp_offset_p");
3634     gp_offset = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(gp_offset_p, "gp_offset");
3635     InRegs = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 48 - neededInt * 8);
3636     InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULE(gp_offset, InRegs, "fits_in_gp");
3637   }
3638 
3639   if (neededSSE) {
3640     fp_offset_p =
3641         CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 1, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4),
3642                                     "fp_offset_p");
3643     fp_offset = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(fp_offset_p, "fp_offset");
3644     llvm::Value *FitsInFP =
3645       llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 176 - neededSSE * 16);
3646     FitsInFP = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULE(fp_offset, FitsInFP, "fits_in_fp");
3647     InRegs = InRegs ? CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(InRegs, FitsInFP) : FitsInFP;
3648   }
3649 
3650   llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg");
3651   llvm::BasicBlock *InMemBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_mem");
3652   llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end");
3653   CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, InMemBlock);
3654 
3655   // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in registers.
3656 
3657   CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock);
3658 
3659   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 4. Fetch type from l->reg_save_area with
3660   // an offset of l->gp_offset and/or l->fp_offset. This may require
3661   // copying to a temporary location in case the parameter is passed
3662   // in different register classes or requires an alignment greater
3663   // than 8 for general purpose registers and 16 for XMM registers.
3664   //
3665   // FIXME: This really results in shameful code when we end up needing to
3666   // collect arguments from different places; often what should result in a
3667   // simple assembling of a structure from scattered addresses has many more
3668   // loads than necessary. Can we clean this up?
3669   llvm::Type *LTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty);
3670   llvm::Value *RegSaveArea = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(
3671       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)),
3672                                   "reg_save_area");
3673 
3674   Address RegAddr = Address::invalid();
3675   if (neededInt && neededSSE) {
3676     // FIXME: Cleanup.
3677     assert(AI.isDirect() && "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs");
3678     llvm::StructType *ST = cast<llvm::StructType>(AI.getCoerceToType());
3679     Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty);
3680     Tmp = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, ST);
3681     assert(ST->getNumElements() == 2 && "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs");
3682     llvm::Type *TyLo = ST->getElementType(0);
3683     llvm::Type *TyHi = ST->getElementType(1);
3684     assert((TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ^ TyHi->isFPOrFPVectorTy()) &&
3685            "Unexpected ABI info for mixed regs");
3686     llvm::Type *PTyLo = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(TyLo);
3687     llvm::Type *PTyHi = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(TyHi);
3688     llvm::Value *GPAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, gp_offset);
3689     llvm::Value *FPAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset);
3690     llvm::Value *RegLoAddr = TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ? FPAddr : GPAddr;
3691     llvm::Value *RegHiAddr = TyLo->isFPOrFPVectorTy() ? GPAddr : FPAddr;
3692 
3693     // Copy the first element.
3694     // FIXME: Our choice of alignment here and below is probably pessimistic.
3695     llvm::Value *V = CGF.Builder.CreateAlignedLoad(
3696         TyLo, CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(RegLoAddr, PTyLo),
3697         CharUnits::fromQuantity(getDataLayout().getABITypeAlignment(TyLo)));
3698     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V,
3699                     CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 0, CharUnits::Zero()));
3700 
3701     // Copy the second element.
3702     V = CGF.Builder.CreateAlignedLoad(
3703         TyHi, CGF.Builder.CreateBitCast(RegHiAddr, PTyHi),
3704         CharUnits::fromQuantity(getDataLayout().getABITypeAlignment(TyHi)));
3705     CharUnits Offset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(
3706                    getDataLayout().getStructLayout(ST)->getElementOffset(1));
3707     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 1, Offset));
3708 
3709     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, LTy);
3710   } else if (neededInt) {
3711     RegAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, gp_offset),
3712                       CharUnits::fromQuantity(8));
3713     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, LTy);
3714 
3715     // Copy to a temporary if necessary to ensure the appropriate alignment.
3716     std::pair<CharUnits, CharUnits> SizeAlign =
3717         getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
3718     uint64_t TySize = SizeAlign.first.getQuantity();
3719     CharUnits TyAlign = SizeAlign.second;
3720 
3721     // Copy into a temporary if the type is more aligned than the
3722     // register save area.
3723     if (TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) {
3724       Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty);
3725       CGF.Builder.CreateMemCpy(Tmp, RegAddr, TySize, false);
3726       RegAddr = Tmp;
3727     }
3728 
3729   } else if (neededSSE == 1) {
3730     RegAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset),
3731                       CharUnits::fromQuantity(16));
3732     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, LTy);
3733   } else {
3734     assert(neededSSE == 2 && "Invalid number of needed registers!");
3735     // SSE registers are spaced 16 bytes apart in the register save
3736     // area, we need to collect the two eightbytes together.
3737     // The ABI isn't explicit about this, but it seems reasonable
3738     // to assume that the slots are 16-byte aligned, since the stack is
3739     // naturally 16-byte aligned and the prologue is expected to store
3740     // all the SSE registers to the RSA.
3741     Address RegAddrLo = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, fp_offset),
3742                                 CharUnits::fromQuantity(16));
3743     Address RegAddrHi =
3744       CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RegAddrLo,
3745                                              CharUnits::fromQuantity(16));
3746     llvm::Type *DoubleTy = CGF.DoubleTy;
3747     llvm::StructType *ST = llvm::StructType::get(DoubleTy, DoubleTy);
3748     llvm::Value *V;
3749     Address Tmp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty);
3750     Tmp = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, ST);
3751     V = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(
3752                    CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddrLo, DoubleTy));
3753     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V,
3754                    CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 0, CharUnits::Zero()));
3755     V = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(
3756                    CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddrHi, DoubleTy));
3757     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V,
3758           CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(Tmp, 1, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8)));
3759 
3760     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, LTy);
3761   }
3762 
3763   // AMD64-ABI 3.5.7p5: Step 5. Set:
3764   // l->gp_offset = l->gp_offset + num_gp * 8
3765   // l->fp_offset = l->fp_offset + num_fp * 16.
3766   if (neededInt) {
3767     llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, neededInt * 8);
3768     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(gp_offset, Offset),
3769                             gp_offset_p);
3770   }
3771   if (neededSSE) {
3772     llvm::Value *Offset = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, neededSSE * 16);
3773     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(fp_offset, Offset),
3774                             fp_offset_p);
3775   }
3776   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
3777 
3778   // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in memory.
3779 
3780   CGF.EmitBlock(InMemBlock);
3781   Address MemAddr = EmitX86_64VAArgFromMemory(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty);
3782 
3783   // Return the appropriate result.
3784 
3785   CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock);
3786   Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock, MemAddr, InMemBlock,
3787                                  "vaarg.addr");
3788   return ResAddr;
3789 }
3790 
3791 Address X86_64ABIInfo::EmitMSVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
3792                                    QualType Ty) const {
3793   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false,
3794                           CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty),
3795                           CharUnits::fromQuantity(8),
3796                           /*allowHigherAlign*/ false);
3797 }
3798 
3799 ABIArgInfo
3800 WinX86_64ABIInfo::reclassifyHvaArgType(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs,
3801                                     const ABIArgInfo &current) const {
3802   // Assumes vectorCall calling convention.
3803   const Type *Base = nullptr;
3804   uint64_t NumElts = 0;
3805 
3806   if (!Ty->isBuiltinType() && !Ty->isVectorType() &&
3807       isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts) && FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) {
3808     FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
3809     return getDirectX86Hva();
3810   }
3811   return current;
3812 }
3813 
3814 ABIArgInfo WinX86_64ABIInfo::classify(QualType Ty, unsigned &FreeSSERegs,
3815                                       bool IsReturnType, bool IsVectorCall,
3816                                       bool IsRegCall) const {
3817 
3818   if (Ty->isVoidType())
3819     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
3820 
3821   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
3822     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
3823 
3824   TypeInfo Info = getContext().getTypeInfo(Ty);
3825   uint64_t Width = Info.Width;
3826   CharUnits Align = getContext().toCharUnitsFromBits(Info.Align);
3827 
3828   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
3829   if (RT) {
3830     if (!IsReturnType) {
3831       if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI()))
3832         return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
3833     }
3834 
3835     if (RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
3836       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
3837 
3838   }
3839 
3840   const Type *Base = nullptr;
3841   uint64_t NumElts = 0;
3842   // vectorcall adds the concept of a homogenous vector aggregate, similar to
3843   // other targets.
3844   if ((IsVectorCall || IsRegCall) &&
3845       isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumElts)) {
3846     if (IsRegCall) {
3847       if (FreeSSERegs >= NumElts) {
3848         FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
3849         if (IsReturnType || Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType())
3850           return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
3851         return ABIArgInfo::getExpand();
3852       }
3853       return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false);
3854     } else if (IsVectorCall) {
3855       if (FreeSSERegs >= NumElts &&
3856           (IsReturnType || Ty->isBuiltinType() || Ty->isVectorType())) {
3857         FreeSSERegs -= NumElts;
3858         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
3859       } else if (IsReturnType) {
3860         return ABIArgInfo::getExpand();
3861       } else if (!Ty->isBuiltinType() && !Ty->isVectorType()) {
3862         // HVAs are delayed and reclassified in the 2nd step.
3863         return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false);
3864       }
3865     }
3866   }
3867 
3868   if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
3869     // If the member pointer is represented by an LLVM int or ptr, pass it
3870     // directly.
3871     llvm::Type *LLTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
3872     if (LLTy->isPointerTy() || LLTy->isIntegerTy())
3873       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
3874   }
3875 
3876   if (RT || Ty->isAnyComplexType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
3877     // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is
3878     // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference."
3879     if (Width > 64 || !llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width))
3880       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
3881 
3882     // Otherwise, coerce it to a small integer.
3883     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Width));
3884   }
3885 
3886   // Bool type is always extended to the ABI, other builtin types are not
3887   // extended.
3888   const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
3889   if (BT && BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Bool)
3890     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend();
3891 
3892   // Mingw64 GCC uses the old 80 bit extended precision floating point unit. It
3893   // passes them indirectly through memory.
3894   if (IsMingw64 && BT && BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) {
3895     const llvm::fltSemantics *LDF = &getTarget().getLongDoubleFormat();
3896     if (LDF == &llvm::APFloat::x87DoubleExtended())
3897       return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(Align, /*ByVal=*/false);
3898   }
3899 
3900   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
3901 }
3902 
3903 void WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeVectorCallArgs(CGFunctionInfo &FI,
3904                                              unsigned FreeSSERegs,
3905                                              bool IsVectorCall,
3906                                              bool IsRegCall) const {
3907   unsigned Count = 0;
3908   for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) {
3909     // Vectorcall in x64 only permits the first 6 arguments to be passed
3910     // as XMM/YMM registers.
3911     if (Count < VectorcallMaxParamNumAsReg)
3912       I.info = classify(I.type, FreeSSERegs, false, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall);
3913     else {
3914       // Since these cannot be passed in registers, pretend no registers
3915       // are left.
3916       unsigned ZeroSSERegsAvail = 0;
3917       I.info = classify(I.type, /*FreeSSERegs=*/ZeroSSERegsAvail, false,
3918                         IsVectorCall, IsRegCall);
3919     }
3920     ++Count;
3921   }
3922 
3923   for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) {
3924     I.info = reclassifyHvaArgType(I.type, FreeSSERegs, I.info);
3925   }
3926 }
3927 
3928 void WinX86_64ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
3929   bool IsVectorCall =
3930       FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_VectorCall;
3931   bool IsRegCall = FI.getCallingConvention() == llvm::CallingConv::X86_RegCall;
3932 
3933   unsigned FreeSSERegs = 0;
3934   if (IsVectorCall) {
3935     // We can use up to 4 SSE return registers with vectorcall.
3936     FreeSSERegs = 4;
3937   } else if (IsRegCall) {
3938     // RegCall gives us 16 SSE registers.
3939     FreeSSERegs = 16;
3940   }
3941 
3942   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
3943     FI.getReturnInfo() = classify(FI.getReturnType(), FreeSSERegs, true,
3944                                   IsVectorCall, IsRegCall);
3945 
3946   if (IsVectorCall) {
3947     // We can use up to 6 SSE register parameters with vectorcall.
3948     FreeSSERegs = 6;
3949   } else if (IsRegCall) {
3950     // RegCall gives us 16 SSE registers, we can reuse the return registers.
3951     FreeSSERegs = 16;
3952   }
3953 
3954   if (IsVectorCall) {
3955     computeVectorCallArgs(FI, FreeSSERegs, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall);
3956   } else {
3957     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
3958       I.info = classify(I.type, FreeSSERegs, false, IsVectorCall, IsRegCall);
3959   }
3960 
3961 }
3962 
3963 Address WinX86_64ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
3964                                     QualType Ty) const {
3965 
3966   bool IsIndirect = false;
3967 
3968   // MS x64 ABI requirement: "Any argument that doesn't fit in 8 bytes, or is
3969   // not 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes, must be passed by reference."
3970   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) || Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
3971     uint64_t Width = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
3972     IsIndirect = Width > 64 || !llvm::isPowerOf2_64(Width);
3973   }
3974 
3975   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect,
3976                           CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty),
3977                           CharUnits::fromQuantity(8),
3978                           /*allowHigherAlign*/ false);
3979 }
3980 
3981 // PowerPC-32
3982 namespace {
3983 /// PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo - The 32-bit PowerPC ELF (SVR4) ABI information.
3984 class PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
3985 bool IsSoftFloatABI;
3986 public:
3987   PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool SoftFloatABI)
3988       : DefaultABIInfo(CGT), IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI) {}
3989 
3990   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
3991                     QualType Ty) const override;
3992 };
3993 
3994 class PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
3995 public:
3996   PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool SoftFloatABI)
3997       : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo(CGT, SoftFloatABI)) {}
3998 
3999   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
4000     // This is recovered from gcc output.
4001     return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer
4002   }
4003 
4004   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4005                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
4006 };
4007 
4008 }
4009 
4010 // TODO: this implementation is now likely redundant with
4011 // DefaultABIInfo::EmitVAArg.
4012 Address PPC32_SVR4_ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAList,
4013                                       QualType Ty) const {
4014   const unsigned OverflowLimit = 8;
4015   if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) {
4016     // TODO: Implement this. For now ignore.
4017     (void)CTy;
4018     return Address::invalid(); // FIXME?
4019   }
4020 
4021   // struct __va_list_tag {
4022   //   unsigned char gpr;
4023   //   unsigned char fpr;
4024   //   unsigned short reserved;
4025   //   void *overflow_arg_area;
4026   //   void *reg_save_area;
4027   // };
4028 
4029   bool isI64 = Ty->isIntegerType() && getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 64;
4030   bool isInt =
4031       Ty->isIntegerType() || Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isAggregateType();
4032   bool isF64 = Ty->isFloatingType() && getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 64;
4033 
4034   // All aggregates are passed indirectly?  That doesn't seem consistent
4035   // with the argument-lowering code.
4036   bool isIndirect = Ty->isAggregateType();
4037 
4038   CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
4039 
4040   // The calling convention either uses 1-2 GPRs or 1 FPR.
4041   Address NumRegsAddr = Address::invalid();
4042   if (isInt || IsSoftFloatABI) {
4043     NumRegsAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 0, CharUnits::Zero(), "gpr");
4044   } else {
4045     NumRegsAddr = Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 1, CharUnits::One(), "fpr");
4046   }
4047 
4048   llvm::Value *NumRegs = Builder.CreateLoad(NumRegsAddr, "numUsedRegs");
4049 
4050   // "Align" the register count when TY is i64.
4051   if (isI64 || (isF64 && IsSoftFloatABI)) {
4052     NumRegs = Builder.CreateAdd(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(1));
4053     NumRegs = Builder.CreateAnd(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8((uint8_t) ~1U));
4054   }
4055 
4056   llvm::Value *CC =
4057       Builder.CreateICmpULT(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(OverflowLimit), "cond");
4058 
4059   llvm::BasicBlock *UsingRegs = CGF.createBasicBlock("using_regs");
4060   llvm::BasicBlock *UsingOverflow = CGF.createBasicBlock("using_overflow");
4061   llvm::BasicBlock *Cont = CGF.createBasicBlock("cont");
4062 
4063   Builder.CreateCondBr(CC, UsingRegs, UsingOverflow);
4064 
4065   llvm::Type *DirectTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty);
4066   if (isIndirect) DirectTy = DirectTy->getPointerTo(0);
4067 
4068   // Case 1: consume registers.
4069   Address RegAddr = Address::invalid();
4070   {
4071     CGF.EmitBlock(UsingRegs);
4072 
4073     Address RegSaveAreaPtr =
4074       Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 4, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8));
4075     RegAddr = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(RegSaveAreaPtr),
4076                       CharUnits::fromQuantity(8));
4077     assert(RegAddr.getElementType() == CGF.Int8Ty);
4078 
4079     // Floating-point registers start after the general-purpose registers.
4080     if (!(isInt || IsSoftFloatABI)) {
4081       RegAddr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RegAddr,
4082                                                    CharUnits::fromQuantity(32));
4083     }
4084 
4085     // Get the address of the saved value by scaling the number of
4086     // registers we've used by the number of
4087     CharUnits RegSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity((isInt || IsSoftFloatABI) ? 4 : 8);
4088     llvm::Value *RegOffset =
4089       Builder.CreateMul(NumRegs, Builder.getInt8(RegSize.getQuantity()));
4090     RegAddr = Address(Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(CGF.Int8Ty,
4091                                             RegAddr.getPointer(), RegOffset),
4092                       RegAddr.getAlignment().alignmentOfArrayElement(RegSize));
4093     RegAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RegAddr, DirectTy);
4094 
4095     // Increase the used-register count.
4096     NumRegs =
4097       Builder.CreateAdd(NumRegs,
4098                         Builder.getInt8((isI64 || (isF64 && IsSoftFloatABI)) ? 2 : 1));
4099     Builder.CreateStore(NumRegs, NumRegsAddr);
4100 
4101     CGF.EmitBranch(Cont);
4102   }
4103 
4104   // Case 2: consume space in the overflow area.
4105   Address MemAddr = Address::invalid();
4106   {
4107     CGF.EmitBlock(UsingOverflow);
4108 
4109     Builder.CreateStore(Builder.getInt8(OverflowLimit), NumRegsAddr);
4110 
4111     // Everything in the overflow area is rounded up to a size of at least 4.
4112     CharUnits OverflowAreaAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
4113 
4114     CharUnits Size;
4115     if (!isIndirect) {
4116       auto TypeInfo = CGF.getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
4117       Size = TypeInfo.first.alignTo(OverflowAreaAlign);
4118     } else {
4119       Size = CGF.getPointerSize();
4120     }
4121 
4122     Address OverflowAreaAddr =
4123       Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAList, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4));
4124     Address OverflowArea(Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowAreaAddr, "argp.cur"),
4125                          OverflowAreaAlign);
4126     // Round up address of argument to alignment
4127     CharUnits Align = CGF.getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty);
4128     if (Align > OverflowAreaAlign) {
4129       llvm::Value *Ptr = OverflowArea.getPointer();
4130       OverflowArea = Address(emitRoundPointerUpToAlignment(CGF, Ptr, Align),
4131                                                            Align);
4132     }
4133 
4134     MemAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OverflowArea, DirectTy);
4135 
4136     // Increase the overflow area.
4137     OverflowArea = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(OverflowArea, Size);
4138     Builder.CreateStore(OverflowArea.getPointer(), OverflowAreaAddr);
4139     CGF.EmitBranch(Cont);
4140   }
4141 
4142   CGF.EmitBlock(Cont);
4143 
4144   // Merge the cases with a phi.
4145   Address Result = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, UsingRegs, MemAddr, UsingOverflow,
4146                                 "vaarg.addr");
4147 
4148   // Load the pointer if the argument was passed indirectly.
4149   if (isIndirect) {
4150     Result = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(Result, "aggr"),
4151                      getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty));
4152   }
4153 
4154   return Result;
4155 }
4156 
4157 bool
4158 PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4159                                                 llvm::Value *Address) const {
4160   // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified
4161   // against gcc output.  AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding.
4162 
4163   CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
4164 
4165   llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty;
4166   llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4);
4167   llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8);
4168   llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 16);
4169 
4170   // 0-31: r0-31, the 4-byte general-purpose registers
4171   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 31);
4172 
4173   // 32-63: fp0-31, the 8-byte floating-point registers
4174   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 32, 63);
4175 
4176   // 64-76 are various 4-byte special-purpose registers:
4177   // 64: mq
4178   // 65: lr
4179   // 66: ctr
4180   // 67: ap
4181   // 68-75 cr0-7
4182   // 76: xer
4183   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 64, 76);
4184 
4185   // 77-108: v0-31, the 16-byte vector registers
4186   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 77, 108);
4187 
4188   // 109: vrsave
4189   // 110: vscr
4190   // 111: spe_acc
4191   // 112: spefscr
4192   // 113: sfp
4193   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 109, 113);
4194 
4195   return false;
4196 }
4197 
4198 // PowerPC-64
4199 
4200 namespace {
4201 /// PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo - The 64-bit PowerPC ELF (SVR4) ABI information.
4202 class PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
4203 public:
4204   enum ABIKind {
4205     ELFv1 = 0,
4206     ELFv2
4207   };
4208 
4209 private:
4210   static const unsigned GPRBits = 64;
4211   ABIKind Kind;
4212   bool HasQPX;
4213   bool IsSoftFloatABI;
4214 
4215   // A vector of float or double will be promoted to <4 x f32> or <4 x f64> and
4216   // will be passed in a QPX register.
4217   bool IsQPXVectorTy(const Type *Ty) const {
4218     if (!HasQPX)
4219       return false;
4220 
4221     if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4222       unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements();
4223       if (NumElements == 1)
4224         return false;
4225 
4226       if (VT->getElementType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Double)) {
4227         if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 256)
4228           return true;
4229       } else if (VT->getElementType()->
4230                    isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) {
4231         if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 128)
4232           return true;
4233       }
4234     }
4235 
4236     return false;
4237   }
4238 
4239   bool IsQPXVectorTy(QualType Ty) const {
4240     return IsQPXVectorTy(Ty.getTypePtr());
4241   }
4242 
4243 public:
4244   PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind, bool HasQPX,
4245                      bool SoftFloatABI)
4246       : ABIInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind), HasQPX(HasQPX),
4247         IsSoftFloatABI(SoftFloatABI) {}
4248 
4249   bool isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const;
4250   CharUnits getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const;
4251 
4252   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
4253   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
4254 
4255   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override;
4256   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty,
4257                                          uint64_t Members) const override;
4258 
4259   // TODO: We can add more logic to computeInfo to improve performance.
4260   // Example: For aggregate arguments that fit in a register, we could
4261   // use getDirectInReg (as is done below for structs containing a single
4262   // floating-point value) to avoid pushing them to memory on function
4263   // entry.  This would require changing the logic in PPCISelLowering
4264   // when lowering the parameters in the caller and args in the callee.
4265   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
4266     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
4267       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
4268     for (auto &I : FI.arguments()) {
4269       // We rely on the default argument classification for the most part.
4270       // One exception:  An aggregate containing a single floating-point
4271       // or vector item must be passed in a register if one is available.
4272       const Type *T = isSingleElementStruct(I.type, getContext());
4273       if (T) {
4274         const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>();
4275         if (IsQPXVectorTy(T) ||
4276             (T->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(T) == 128) ||
4277             (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint())) {
4278           QualType QT(T, 0);
4279           I.info = ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(CGT.ConvertType(QT));
4280           continue;
4281         }
4282       }
4283       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
4284     }
4285   }
4286 
4287   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
4288                     QualType Ty) const override;
4289 };
4290 
4291 class PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
4292 
4293 public:
4294   PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT,
4295                                PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind, bool HasQPX,
4296                                bool SoftFloatABI)
4297       : TargetCodeGenInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo(CGT, Kind, HasQPX,
4298                                                  SoftFloatABI)) {}
4299 
4300   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
4301     // This is recovered from gcc output.
4302     return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer
4303   }
4304 
4305   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4306                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
4307 };
4308 
4309 class PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo : public DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo {
4310 public:
4311   PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT) {}
4312 
4313   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
4314     // This is recovered from gcc output.
4315     return 1; // r1 is the dedicated stack pointer
4316   }
4317 
4318   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4319                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
4320 };
4321 
4322 }
4323 
4324 // Return true if the ABI requires Ty to be passed sign- or zero-
4325 // extended to 64 bits.
4326 bool
4327 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isPromotableTypeForABI(QualType Ty) const {
4328   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
4329   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
4330     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
4331 
4332   // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI.
4333   if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType())
4334     return true;
4335 
4336   // In addition to the usual promotable integer types, we also need to
4337   // extend all 32-bit types, since the ABI requires promotion to 64 bits.
4338   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
4339     switch (BT->getKind()) {
4340     case BuiltinType::Int:
4341     case BuiltinType::UInt:
4342       return true;
4343     default:
4344       break;
4345     }
4346 
4347   return false;
4348 }
4349 
4350 /// isAlignedParamType - Determine whether a type requires 16-byte or
4351 /// higher alignment in the parameter area.  Always returns at least 8.
4352 CharUnits PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::getParamTypeAlignment(QualType Ty) const {
4353   // Complex types are passed just like their elements.
4354   if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>())
4355     Ty = CTy->getElementType();
4356 
4357   // Only vector types of size 16 bytes need alignment (larger types are
4358   // passed via reference, smaller types are not aligned).
4359   if (IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) {
4360     if (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) > 128)
4361       return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32);
4362 
4363     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16);
4364   } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
4365     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) == 128 ? 16 : 8);
4366   }
4367 
4368   // For single-element float/vector structs, we consider the whole type
4369   // to have the same alignment requirements as its single element.
4370   const Type *AlignAsType = nullptr;
4371   const Type *EltType = isSingleElementStruct(Ty, getContext());
4372   if (EltType) {
4373     const BuiltinType *BT = EltType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
4374     if (IsQPXVectorTy(EltType) || (EltType->isVectorType() &&
4375          getContext().getTypeSize(EltType) == 128) ||
4376         (BT && BT->isFloatingPoint()))
4377       AlignAsType = EltType;
4378   }
4379 
4380   // Likewise for ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates.
4381   const Type *Base = nullptr;
4382   uint64_t Members = 0;
4383   if (!AlignAsType && Kind == ELFv2 &&
4384       isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members))
4385     AlignAsType = Base;
4386 
4387   // With special case aggregates, only vector base types need alignment.
4388   if (AlignAsType && IsQPXVectorTy(AlignAsType)) {
4389     if (getContext().getTypeSize(AlignAsType) > 128)
4390       return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32);
4391 
4392     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16);
4393   } else if (AlignAsType) {
4394     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(AlignAsType->isVectorType() ? 16 : 8);
4395   }
4396 
4397   // Otherwise, we only need alignment for any aggregate type that
4398   // has an alignment requirement of >= 16 bytes.
4399   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) >= 128) {
4400     if (HasQPX && getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) >= 256)
4401       return CharUnits::fromQuantity(32);
4402     return CharUnits::fromQuantity(16);
4403   }
4404 
4405   return CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
4406 }
4407 
4408 /// isHomogeneousAggregate - Return true if a type is an ELFv2 homogeneous
4409 /// aggregate.  Base is set to the base element type, and Members is set
4410 /// to the number of base elements.
4411 bool ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregate(QualType Ty, const Type *&Base,
4412                                      uint64_t &Members) const {
4413   if (const ConstantArrayType *AT = getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(Ty)) {
4414     uint64_t NElements = AT->getSize().getZExtValue();
4415     if (NElements == 0)
4416       return false;
4417     if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(AT->getElementType(), Base, Members))
4418       return false;
4419     Members *= NElements;
4420   } else if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
4421     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
4422     if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
4423       return false;
4424 
4425     Members = 0;
4426 
4427     // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
4428     if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
4429       for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) {
4430         // Ignore empty records.
4431         if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), I.getType(), true))
4432           continue;
4433 
4434         uint64_t FldMembers;
4435         if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(I.getType(), Base, FldMembers))
4436           return false;
4437 
4438         Members += FldMembers;
4439       }
4440     }
4441 
4442     for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
4443       // Ignore (non-zero arrays of) empty records.
4444       QualType FT = FD->getType();
4445       while (const ConstantArrayType *AT =
4446              getContext().getAsConstantArrayType(FT)) {
4447         if (AT->getSize().getZExtValue() == 0)
4448           return false;
4449         FT = AT->getElementType();
4450       }
4451       if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), FT, true))
4452         continue;
4453 
4454       // For compatibility with GCC, ignore empty bitfields in C++ mode.
4455       if (getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
4456           FD->isBitField() && FD->getBitWidthValue(getContext()) == 0)
4457         continue;
4458 
4459       uint64_t FldMembers;
4460       if (!isHomogeneousAggregate(FD->getType(), Base, FldMembers))
4461         return false;
4462 
4463       Members = (RD->isUnion() ?
4464                  std::max(Members, FldMembers) : Members + FldMembers);
4465     }
4466 
4467     if (!Base)
4468       return false;
4469 
4470     // Ensure there is no padding.
4471     if (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) * Members !=
4472         getContext().getTypeSize(Ty))
4473       return false;
4474   } else {
4475     Members = 1;
4476     if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) {
4477       Members = 2;
4478       Ty = CT->getElementType();
4479     }
4480 
4481     // Most ABIs only support float, double, and some vector type widths.
4482     if (!isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(Ty))
4483       return false;
4484 
4485     // The base type must be the same for all members.  Types that
4486     // agree in both total size and mode (float vs. vector) are
4487     // treated as being equivalent here.
4488     const Type *TyPtr = Ty.getTypePtr();
4489     if (!Base) {
4490       Base = TyPtr;
4491       // If it's a non-power-of-2 vector, its size is already a power-of-2,
4492       // so make sure to widen it explicitly.
4493       if (const VectorType *VT = Base->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4494         QualType EltTy = VT->getElementType();
4495         unsigned NumElements =
4496             getContext().getTypeSize(VT) / getContext().getTypeSize(EltTy);
4497         Base = getContext()
4498                    .getVectorType(EltTy, NumElements, VT->getVectorKind())
4499                    .getTypePtr();
4500       }
4501     }
4502 
4503     if (Base->isVectorType() != TyPtr->isVectorType() ||
4504         getContext().getTypeSize(Base) != getContext().getTypeSize(TyPtr))
4505       return false;
4506   }
4507   return Members > 0 && isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(Base, Members);
4508 }
4509 
4510 bool PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
4511   // Homogeneous aggregates for ELFv2 must have base types of float,
4512   // double, long double, or 128-bit vectors.
4513   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
4514     if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
4515         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double ||
4516         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble) {
4517       if (IsSoftFloatABI)
4518         return false;
4519       return true;
4520     }
4521   }
4522   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
4523     if (getContext().getTypeSize(VT) == 128 || IsQPXVectorTy(Ty))
4524       return true;
4525   }
4526   return false;
4527 }
4528 
4529 bool PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(
4530     const Type *Base, uint64_t Members) const {
4531   // Vector types require one register, floating point types require one
4532   // or two registers depending on their size.
4533   uint32_t NumRegs =
4534       Base->isVectorType() ? 1 : (getContext().getTypeSize(Base) + 63) / 64;
4535 
4536   // Homogeneous Aggregates may occupy at most 8 registers.
4537   return Members * NumRegs <= 8;
4538 }
4539 
4540 ABIArgInfo
4541 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
4542   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
4543 
4544   if (Ty->isAnyComplexType())
4545     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
4546 
4547   // Non-Altivec vector types are passed in GPRs (smaller than 16 bytes)
4548   // or via reference (larger than 16 bytes).
4549   if (Ty->isVectorType() && !IsQPXVectorTy(Ty)) {
4550     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
4551     if (Size > 128)
4552       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
4553     else if (Size < 128) {
4554       llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size);
4555       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
4556     }
4557   }
4558 
4559   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
4560     if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
4561       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
4562 
4563     uint64_t ABIAlign = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty).getQuantity();
4564     uint64_t TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty).getQuantity();
4565 
4566     // ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates are passed as array types.
4567     const Type *Base = nullptr;
4568     uint64_t Members = 0;
4569     if (Kind == ELFv2 &&
4570         isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) {
4571       llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0));
4572       llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Members);
4573       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
4574     }
4575 
4576     // If an aggregate may end up fully in registers, we do not
4577     // use the ByVal method, but pass the aggregate as array.
4578     // This is usually beneficial since we avoid forcing the
4579     // back-end to store the argument to memory.
4580     uint64_t Bits = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
4581     if (Bits > 0 && Bits <= 8 * GPRBits) {
4582       llvm::Type *CoerceTy;
4583 
4584       // Types up to 8 bytes are passed as integer type (which will be
4585       // properly aligned in the argument save area doubleword).
4586       if (Bits <= GPRBits)
4587         CoerceTy =
4588             llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), llvm::alignTo(Bits, 8));
4589       // Larger types are passed as arrays, with the base type selected
4590       // according to the required alignment in the save area.
4591       else {
4592         uint64_t RegBits = ABIAlign * 8;
4593         uint64_t NumRegs = llvm::alignTo(Bits, RegBits) / RegBits;
4594         llvm::Type *RegTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), RegBits);
4595         CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(RegTy, NumRegs);
4596       }
4597 
4598       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
4599     }
4600 
4601     // All other aggregates are passed ByVal.
4602     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(ABIAlign),
4603                                    /*ByVal=*/true,
4604                                    /*Realign=*/TyAlign > ABIAlign);
4605   }
4606 
4607   return (isPromotableTypeForABI(Ty) ?
4608           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
4609 }
4610 
4611 ABIArgInfo
4612 PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
4613   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
4614     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
4615 
4616   if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
4617     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
4618 
4619   // Non-Altivec vector types are returned in GPRs (smaller than 16 bytes)
4620   // or via reference (larger than 16 bytes).
4621   if (RetTy->isVectorType() && !IsQPXVectorTy(RetTy)) {
4622     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
4623     if (Size > 128)
4624       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
4625     else if (Size < 128) {
4626       llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size);
4627       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
4628     }
4629   }
4630 
4631   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
4632     // ELFv2 homogeneous aggregates are returned as array types.
4633     const Type *Base = nullptr;
4634     uint64_t Members = 0;
4635     if (Kind == ELFv2 &&
4636         isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) {
4637       llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0));
4638       llvm::Type *CoerceTy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Members);
4639       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
4640     }
4641 
4642     // ELFv2 small aggregates are returned in up to two registers.
4643     uint64_t Bits = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
4644     if (Kind == ELFv2 && Bits <= 2 * GPRBits) {
4645       if (Bits == 0)
4646         return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
4647 
4648       llvm::Type *CoerceTy;
4649       if (Bits > GPRBits) {
4650         CoerceTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), GPRBits);
4651         CoerceTy = llvm::StructType::get(CoerceTy, CoerceTy);
4652       } else
4653         CoerceTy =
4654             llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), llvm::alignTo(Bits, 8));
4655       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
4656     }
4657 
4658     // All other aggregates are returned indirectly.
4659     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
4660   }
4661 
4662   return (isPromotableTypeForABI(RetTy) ?
4663           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
4664 }
4665 
4666 // Based on ARMABIInfo::EmitVAArg, adjusted for 64-bit machine.
4667 Address PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
4668                                       QualType Ty) const {
4669   auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
4670   TypeInfo.second = getParamTypeAlignment(Ty);
4671 
4672   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
4673 
4674   // If we have a complex type and the base type is smaller than 8 bytes,
4675   // the ABI calls for the real and imaginary parts to be right-adjusted
4676   // in separate doublewords.  However, Clang expects us to produce a
4677   // pointer to a structure with the two parts packed tightly.  So generate
4678   // loads of the real and imaginary parts relative to the va_list pointer,
4679   // and store them to a temporary structure.
4680   if (const ComplexType *CTy = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>()) {
4681     CharUnits EltSize = TypeInfo.first / 2;
4682     if (EltSize < SlotSize) {
4683       Address Addr = emitVoidPtrDirectVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, CGF.Int8Ty,
4684                                             SlotSize * 2, SlotSize,
4685                                             SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true);
4686 
4687       Address RealAddr = Addr;
4688       Address ImagAddr = RealAddr;
4689       if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian()) {
4690         RealAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RealAddr,
4691                                                           SlotSize - EltSize);
4692         ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(ImagAddr,
4693                                                       2 * SlotSize - EltSize);
4694       } else {
4695         ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(RealAddr, SlotSize);
4696       }
4697 
4698       llvm::Type *EltTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(CTy->getElementType());
4699       RealAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RealAddr, EltTy);
4700       ImagAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(ImagAddr, EltTy);
4701       llvm::Value *Real = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RealAddr, ".vareal");
4702       llvm::Value *Imag = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ImagAddr, ".vaimag");
4703 
4704       Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(Ty, "vacplx");
4705       CGF.EmitStoreOfComplex({Real, Imag}, CGF.MakeAddrLValue(Temp, Ty),
4706                              /*init*/ true);
4707       return Temp;
4708     }
4709   }
4710 
4711   // Otherwise, just use the general rule.
4712   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*Indirect*/ false,
4713                           TypeInfo, SlotSize, /*AllowHigher*/ true);
4714 }
4715 
4716 static bool
4717 PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4718                               llvm::Value *Address) {
4719   // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified
4720   // against gcc output.  AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding.
4721 
4722   CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
4723 
4724   llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty;
4725   llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4);
4726   llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8);
4727   llvm::Value *Sixteen8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 16);
4728 
4729   // 0-31: r0-31, the 8-byte general-purpose registers
4730   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 31);
4731 
4732   // 32-63: fp0-31, the 8-byte floating-point registers
4733   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 32, 63);
4734 
4735   // 64-67 are various 8-byte special-purpose registers:
4736   // 64: mq
4737   // 65: lr
4738   // 66: ctr
4739   // 67: ap
4740   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 64, 67);
4741 
4742   // 68-76 are various 4-byte special-purpose registers:
4743   // 68-75 cr0-7
4744   // 76: xer
4745   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 68, 76);
4746 
4747   // 77-108: v0-31, the 16-byte vector registers
4748   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Sixteen8, 77, 108);
4749 
4750   // 109: vrsave
4751   // 110: vscr
4752   // 111: spe_acc
4753   // 112: spefscr
4754   // 113: sfp
4755   // 114: tfhar
4756   // 115: tfiar
4757   // 116: texasr
4758   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 109, 116);
4759 
4760   return false;
4761 }
4762 
4763 bool
4764 PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(
4765   CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4766   llvm::Value *Address) const {
4767 
4768   return PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address);
4769 }
4770 
4771 bool
4772 PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
4773                                                 llvm::Value *Address) const {
4774 
4775   return PPC64_initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CGF, Address);
4776 }
4777 
4778 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4779 // AArch64 ABI Implementation
4780 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
4781 
4782 namespace {
4783 
4784 class AArch64ABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
4785 public:
4786   enum ABIKind {
4787     AAPCS = 0,
4788     DarwinPCS
4789   };
4790 
4791 private:
4792   ABIKind Kind;
4793 
4794 public:
4795   AArch64ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind Kind)
4796     : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(Kind) {}
4797 
4798 private:
4799   ABIKind getABIKind() const { return Kind; }
4800   bool isDarwinPCS() const { return Kind == DarwinPCS; }
4801 
4802   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
4803   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const;
4804   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override;
4805   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty,
4806                                          uint64_t Members) const override;
4807 
4808   bool isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const;
4809 
4810   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
4811     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
4812       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
4813 
4814     for (auto &it : FI.arguments())
4815       it.info = classifyArgumentType(it.type);
4816   }
4817 
4818   Address EmitDarwinVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty,
4819                           CodeGenFunction &CGF) const;
4820 
4821   Address EmitAAPCSVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty,
4822                          CodeGenFunction &CGF) const;
4823 
4824   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
4825                     QualType Ty) const override {
4826     return isDarwinPCS() ? EmitDarwinVAArg(VAListAddr, Ty, CGF)
4827                          : EmitAAPCSVAArg(VAListAddr, Ty, CGF);
4828   }
4829 
4830   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize,
4831                                     ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
4832                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
4833     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
4834   }
4835   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
4836     return true;
4837   }
4838 
4839   bool isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, llvm::Type *eltTy,
4840                                  unsigned elts) const override;
4841 };
4842 
4843 class AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
4844 public:
4845   AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind)
4846       : TargetCodeGenInfo(new AArch64ABIInfo(CGT, Kind)) {}
4847 
4848   StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override {
4849     return "mov\tfp, fp\t\t# marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue";
4850   }
4851 
4852   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
4853     return 31;
4854   }
4855 
4856   bool doesReturnSlotInterfereWithArgs() const override { return false; }
4857 };
4858 }
4859 
4860 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
4861   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
4862 
4863   // Handle illegal vector types here.
4864   if (isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) {
4865     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
4866     // Android promotes <2 x i8> to i16, not i32
4867     if (isAndroid() && (Size <= 16)) {
4868       llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext());
4869       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
4870     }
4871     if (Size <= 32) {
4872       llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
4873       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
4874     }
4875     if (Size == 64) {
4876       llvm::Type *ResType =
4877           llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 2);
4878       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
4879     }
4880     if (Size == 128) {
4881       llvm::Type *ResType =
4882           llvm::VectorType::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 4);
4883       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
4884     }
4885     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
4886   }
4887 
4888   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
4889     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
4890     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
4891       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
4892 
4893     return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() && isDarwinPCS()
4894                 ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend()
4895                 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
4896   }
4897 
4898   // Structures with either a non-trivial destructor or a non-trivial
4899   // copy constructor are always indirect.
4900   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) {
4901     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/RAA ==
4902                                      CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
4903   }
4904 
4905   // Empty records are always ignored on Darwin, but actually passed in C++ mode
4906   // elsewhere for GNU compatibility.
4907   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
4908   bool IsEmpty = isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true);
4909   if (IsEmpty || Size == 0) {
4910     if (!getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || isDarwinPCS())
4911       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
4912 
4913     // GNU C mode. The only argument that gets ignored is an empty one with size
4914     // 0.
4915     if (IsEmpty && Size == 0)
4916       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
4917     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()));
4918   }
4919 
4920   // Homogeneous Floating-point Aggregates (HFAs) need to be expanded.
4921   const Type *Base = nullptr;
4922   uint64_t Members = 0;
4923   if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) {
4924     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(
4925         llvm::ArrayType::get(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)), Members));
4926   }
4927 
4928   // Aggregates <= 16 bytes are passed directly in registers or on the stack.
4929   if (Size <= 128) {
4930     // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 16 bytes to an integer array of
4931     // same size and alignment.
4932     if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) {
4933       return coerceToIntArray(Ty, getContext(), getVMContext());
4934     }
4935     unsigned Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty);
4936     Size = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64); // round up to multiple of 8 bytes
4937 
4938     // We use a pair of i64 for 16-byte aggregate with 8-byte alignment.
4939     // For aggregates with 16-byte alignment, we use i128.
4940     if (Alignment < 128 && Size == 128) {
4941       llvm::Type *BaseTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext());
4942       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Size / 64));
4943     }
4944     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size));
4945   }
4946 
4947   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
4948 }
4949 
4950 ABIArgInfo AArch64ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
4951   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
4952     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
4953 
4954   // Large vector types should be returned via memory.
4955   if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 128)
4956     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
4957 
4958   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
4959     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
4960     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
4961       RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
4962 
4963     return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() && isDarwinPCS()
4964                 ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend()
4965                 : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
4966   }
4967 
4968   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
4969   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true) || Size == 0)
4970     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
4971 
4972   const Type *Base = nullptr;
4973   uint64_t Members = 0;
4974   if (isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members))
4975     // Homogeneous Floating-point Aggregates (HFAs) are returned directly.
4976     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
4977 
4978   // Aggregates <= 16 bytes are returned directly in registers or on the stack.
4979   if (Size <= 128) {
4980     // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 16 bytes to an integer array of
4981     // same size and alignment.
4982     if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) {
4983       return coerceToIntArray(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext());
4984     }
4985     unsigned Alignment = getContext().getTypeAlign(RetTy);
4986     Size = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64); // round up to multiple of 8 bytes
4987 
4988     // We use a pair of i64 for 16-byte aggregate with 8-byte alignment.
4989     // For aggregates with 16-byte alignment, we use i128.
4990     if (Alignment < 128 && Size == 128) {
4991       llvm::Type *BaseTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext());
4992       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, Size / 64));
4993     }
4994     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size));
4995   }
4996 
4997   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
4998 }
4999 
5000 /// isIllegalVectorType - check whether the vector type is legal for AArch64.
5001 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const {
5002   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5003     // Check whether VT is legal.
5004     unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements();
5005     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
5006     // NumElements should be power of 2.
5007     if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements))
5008       return true;
5009     return Size != 64 && (Size != 128 || NumElements == 1);
5010   }
5011   return false;
5012 }
5013 
5014 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize,
5015                                                llvm::Type *eltTy,
5016                                                unsigned elts) const {
5017   if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(elts))
5018     return false;
5019   if (totalSize.getQuantity() != 8 &&
5020       (totalSize.getQuantity() != 16 || elts == 1))
5021     return false;
5022   return true;
5023 }
5024 
5025 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
5026   // Homogeneous aggregates for AAPCS64 must have base types of a floating
5027   // point type or a short-vector type. This is the same as the 32-bit ABI,
5028   // but with the difference that any floating-point type is allowed,
5029   // including __fp16.
5030   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5031     if (BT->isFloatingPoint())
5032       return true;
5033   } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5034     unsigned VecSize = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
5035     if (VecSize == 64 || VecSize == 128)
5036       return true;
5037   }
5038   return false;
5039 }
5040 
5041 bool AArch64ABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base,
5042                                                        uint64_t Members) const {
5043   return Members <= 4;
5044 }
5045 
5046 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitAAPCSVAArg(Address VAListAddr,
5047                                             QualType Ty,
5048                                             CodeGenFunction &CGF) const {
5049   ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty);
5050   bool IsIndirect = AI.isIndirect();
5051 
5052   llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(Ty);
5053   if (IsIndirect)
5054     BaseTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(BaseTy);
5055   else if (AI.getCoerceToType())
5056     BaseTy = AI.getCoerceToType();
5057 
5058   unsigned NumRegs = 1;
5059   if (llvm::ArrayType *ArrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::ArrayType>(BaseTy)) {
5060     BaseTy = ArrTy->getElementType();
5061     NumRegs = ArrTy->getNumElements();
5062   }
5063   bool IsFPR = BaseTy->isFloatingPointTy() || BaseTy->isVectorTy();
5064 
5065   // The AArch64 va_list type and handling is specified in the Procedure Call
5066   // Standard, section B.4:
5067   //
5068   // struct {
5069   //   void *__stack;
5070   //   void *__gr_top;
5071   //   void *__vr_top;
5072   //   int __gr_offs;
5073   //   int __vr_offs;
5074   // };
5075 
5076   llvm::BasicBlock *MaybeRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.maybe_reg");
5077   llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg");
5078   llvm::BasicBlock *OnStackBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.on_stack");
5079   llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end");
5080 
5081   auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
5082   CharUnits TyAlign = TyInfo.second;
5083 
5084   Address reg_offs_p = Address::invalid();
5085   llvm::Value *reg_offs = nullptr;
5086   int reg_top_index;
5087   CharUnits reg_top_offset;
5088   int RegSize = IsIndirect ? 8 : TyInfo.first.getQuantity();
5089   if (!IsFPR) {
5090     // 3 is the field number of __gr_offs
5091     reg_offs_p =
5092         CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(24),
5093                                     "gr_offs_p");
5094     reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_offs_p, "gr_offs");
5095     reg_top_index = 1; // field number for __gr_top
5096     reg_top_offset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
5097     RegSize = llvm::alignTo(RegSize, 8);
5098   } else {
5099     // 4 is the field number of __vr_offs.
5100     reg_offs_p =
5101         CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 4, CharUnits::fromQuantity(28),
5102                                     "vr_offs_p");
5103     reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_offs_p, "vr_offs");
5104     reg_top_index = 2; // field number for __vr_top
5105     reg_top_offset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16);
5106     RegSize = 16 * NumRegs;
5107   }
5108 
5109   //=======================================
5110   // Find out where argument was passed
5111   //=======================================
5112 
5113   // If reg_offs >= 0 we're already using the stack for this type of
5114   // argument. We don't want to keep updating reg_offs (in case it overflows,
5115   // though anyone passing 2GB of arguments, each at most 16 bytes, deserves
5116   // whatever they get).
5117   llvm::Value *UsingStack = nullptr;
5118   UsingStack = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSGE(
5119       reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 0));
5120 
5121   CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(UsingStack, OnStackBlock, MaybeRegBlock);
5122 
5123   // Otherwise, at least some kind of argument could go in these registers, the
5124   // question is whether this particular type is too big.
5125   CGF.EmitBlock(MaybeRegBlock);
5126 
5127   // Integer arguments may need to correct register alignment (for example a
5128   // "struct { __int128 a; };" gets passed in x_2N, x_{2N+1}). In this case we
5129   // align __gr_offs to calculate the potential address.
5130   if (!IsFPR && !IsIndirect && TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) {
5131     int Align = TyAlign.getQuantity();
5132 
5133     reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(
5134         reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, Align - 1),
5135         "align_regoffs");
5136     reg_offs = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(
5137         reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, -Align),
5138         "aligned_regoffs");
5139   }
5140 
5141   // Update the gr_offs/vr_offs pointer for next call to va_arg on this va_list.
5142   // The fact that this is done unconditionally reflects the fact that
5143   // allocating an argument to the stack also uses up all the remaining
5144   // registers of the appropriate kind.
5145   llvm::Value *NewOffset = nullptr;
5146   NewOffset = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(
5147       reg_offs, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, RegSize), "new_reg_offs");
5148   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOffset, reg_offs_p);
5149 
5150   // Now we're in a position to decide whether this argument really was in
5151   // registers or not.
5152   llvm::Value *InRegs = nullptr;
5153   InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpSLE(
5154       NewOffset, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int32Ty, 0), "inreg");
5155 
5156   CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, OnStackBlock);
5157 
5158   //=======================================
5159   // Argument was in registers
5160   //=======================================
5161 
5162   // Now we emit the code for if the argument was originally passed in
5163   // registers. First start the appropriate block:
5164   CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock);
5165 
5166   llvm::Value *reg_top = nullptr;
5167   Address reg_top_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, reg_top_index,
5168                                                   reg_top_offset, "reg_top_p");
5169   reg_top = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(reg_top_p, "reg_top");
5170   Address BaseAddr(CGF.Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(reg_top, reg_offs),
5171                    CharUnits::fromQuantity(IsFPR ? 16 : 8));
5172   Address RegAddr = Address::invalid();
5173   llvm::Type *MemTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty);
5174 
5175   if (IsIndirect) {
5176     // If it's been passed indirectly (actually a struct), whatever we find from
5177     // stored registers or on the stack will actually be a struct **.
5178     MemTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(MemTy);
5179   }
5180 
5181   const Type *Base = nullptr;
5182   uint64_t NumMembers = 0;
5183   bool IsHFA = isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, NumMembers);
5184   if (IsHFA && NumMembers > 1) {
5185     // Homogeneous aggregates passed in registers will have their elements split
5186     // and stored 16-bytes apart regardless of size (they're notionally in qN,
5187     // qN+1, ...). We reload and store into a temporary local variable
5188     // contiguously.
5189     assert(!IsIndirect && "Homogeneous aggregates should be passed directly");
5190     auto BaseTyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(QualType(Base, 0));
5191     llvm::Type *BaseTy = CGF.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0));
5192     llvm::Type *HFATy = llvm::ArrayType::get(BaseTy, NumMembers);
5193     Address Tmp = CGF.CreateTempAlloca(HFATy,
5194                                        std::max(TyAlign, BaseTyInfo.second));
5195 
5196     // On big-endian platforms, the value will be right-aligned in its slot.
5197     int Offset = 0;
5198     if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() &&
5199         BaseTyInfo.first.getQuantity() < 16)
5200       Offset = 16 - BaseTyInfo.first.getQuantity();
5201 
5202     for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumMembers; ++i) {
5203       CharUnits BaseOffset = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16 * i + Offset);
5204       Address LoadAddr =
5205         CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(BaseAddr, BaseOffset);
5206       LoadAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(LoadAddr, BaseTy);
5207 
5208       Address StoreAddr =
5209         CGF.Builder.CreateConstArrayGEP(Tmp, i, BaseTyInfo.first);
5210 
5211       llvm::Value *Elem = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(LoadAddr);
5212       CGF.Builder.CreateStore(Elem, StoreAddr);
5213     }
5214 
5215     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Tmp, MemTy);
5216   } else {
5217     // Otherwise the object is contiguous in memory.
5218 
5219     // It might be right-aligned in its slot.
5220     CharUnits SlotSize = BaseAddr.getAlignment();
5221     if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && !IsIndirect &&
5222         (IsHFA || !isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) &&
5223         TyInfo.first < SlotSize) {
5224       CharUnits Offset = SlotSize - TyInfo.first;
5225       BaseAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(BaseAddr, Offset);
5226     }
5227 
5228     RegAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(BaseAddr, MemTy);
5229   }
5230 
5231   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
5232 
5233   //=======================================
5234   // Argument was on the stack
5235   //=======================================
5236   CGF.EmitBlock(OnStackBlock);
5237 
5238   Address stack_p = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 0,
5239                                                 CharUnits::Zero(), "stack_p");
5240   llvm::Value *OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(stack_p, "stack");
5241 
5242   // Again, stack arguments may need realignment. In this case both integer and
5243   // floating-point ones might be affected.
5244   if (!IsIndirect && TyAlign.getQuantity() > 8) {
5245     int Align = TyAlign.getQuantity();
5246 
5247     OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreatePtrToInt(OnStackPtr, CGF.Int64Ty);
5248 
5249     OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(
5250         OnStackPtr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, Align - 1),
5251         "align_stack");
5252     OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateAnd(
5253         OnStackPtr, llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int64Ty, -Align),
5254         "align_stack");
5255 
5256     OnStackPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(OnStackPtr, CGF.Int8PtrTy);
5257   }
5258   Address OnStackAddr(OnStackPtr,
5259                       std::max(CharUnits::fromQuantity(8), TyAlign));
5260 
5261   // All stack slots are multiples of 8 bytes.
5262   CharUnits StackSlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
5263   CharUnits StackSize;
5264   if (IsIndirect)
5265     StackSize = StackSlotSize;
5266   else
5267     StackSize = TyInfo.first.alignTo(StackSlotSize);
5268 
5269   llvm::Value *StackSizeC = CGF.Builder.getSize(StackSize);
5270   llvm::Value *NewStack =
5271       CGF.Builder.CreateInBoundsGEP(OnStackPtr, StackSizeC, "new_stack");
5272 
5273   // Write the new value of __stack for the next call to va_arg
5274   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewStack, stack_p);
5275 
5276   if (CGF.CGM.getDataLayout().isBigEndian() && !isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) &&
5277       TyInfo.first < StackSlotSize) {
5278     CharUnits Offset = StackSlotSize - TyInfo.first;
5279     OnStackAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(OnStackAddr, Offset);
5280   }
5281 
5282   OnStackAddr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OnStackAddr, MemTy);
5283 
5284   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
5285 
5286   //=======================================
5287   // Tidy up
5288   //=======================================
5289   CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock);
5290 
5291   Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock,
5292                                  OnStackAddr, OnStackBlock, "vaargs.addr");
5293 
5294   if (IsIndirect)
5295     return Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ResAddr, "vaarg.addr"),
5296                    TyInfo.second);
5297 
5298   return ResAddr;
5299 }
5300 
5301 Address AArch64ABIInfo::EmitDarwinVAArg(Address VAListAddr, QualType Ty,
5302                                         CodeGenFunction &CGF) const {
5303   // The backend's lowering doesn't support va_arg for aggregates or
5304   // illegal vector types.  Lower VAArg here for these cases and use
5305   // the LLVM va_arg instruction for everything else.
5306   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) && !isIllegalVectorType(Ty))
5307     return EmitVAArgInstr(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
5308 
5309   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
5310 
5311   // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes.
5312   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) {
5313     Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "ap.cur"), SlotSize);
5314     Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty));
5315     return Addr;
5316   }
5317 
5318   // The size of the actual thing passed, which might end up just
5319   // being a pointer for indirect types.
5320   auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
5321 
5322   // Arguments bigger than 16 bytes which aren't homogeneous
5323   // aggregates should be passed indirectly.
5324   bool IsIndirect = false;
5325   if (TyInfo.first.getQuantity() > 16) {
5326     const Type *Base = nullptr;
5327     uint64_t Members = 0;
5328     IsIndirect = !isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members);
5329   }
5330 
5331   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect,
5332                           TyInfo, SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true);
5333 }
5334 
5335 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5336 // ARM ABI Implementation
5337 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
5338 
5339 namespace {
5340 
5341 class ARMABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
5342 public:
5343   enum ABIKind {
5344     APCS = 0,
5345     AAPCS = 1,
5346     AAPCS_VFP = 2,
5347     AAPCS16_VFP = 3,
5348   };
5349 
5350 private:
5351   ABIKind Kind;
5352 
5353 public:
5354   ARMABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ABIKind _Kind)
5355       : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), Kind(_Kind) {
5356     setCCs();
5357   }
5358 
5359   bool isEABI() const {
5360     switch (getTarget().getTriple().getEnvironment()) {
5361     case llvm::Triple::Android:
5362     case llvm::Triple::EABI:
5363     case llvm::Triple::EABIHF:
5364     case llvm::Triple::GNUEABI:
5365     case llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF:
5366     case llvm::Triple::MuslEABI:
5367     case llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF:
5368       return true;
5369     default:
5370       return false;
5371     }
5372   }
5373 
5374   bool isEABIHF() const {
5375     switch (getTarget().getTriple().getEnvironment()) {
5376     case llvm::Triple::EABIHF:
5377     case llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF:
5378     case llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF:
5379       return true;
5380     default:
5381       return false;
5382     }
5383   }
5384 
5385   ABIKind getABIKind() const { return Kind; }
5386 
5387 private:
5388   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic) const;
5389   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, bool isVariadic) const;
5390   bool isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const;
5391 
5392   bool isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const override;
5393   bool isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Ty,
5394                                          uint64_t Members) const override;
5395 
5396   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
5397 
5398   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
5399                     QualType Ty) const override;
5400 
5401   llvm::CallingConv::ID getLLVMDefaultCC() const;
5402   llvm::CallingConv::ID getABIDefaultCC() const;
5403   void setCCs();
5404 
5405   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize,
5406                                     ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
5407                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
5408     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
5409   }
5410   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
5411     return true;
5412   }
5413   bool isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits totalSize, llvm::Type *eltTy,
5414                                  unsigned elts) const override;
5415 };
5416 
5417 class ARMTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
5418 public:
5419   ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ARMABIInfo::ABIKind K)
5420     :TargetCodeGenInfo(new ARMABIInfo(CGT, K)) {}
5421 
5422   const ARMABIInfo &getABIInfo() const {
5423     return static_cast<const ARMABIInfo&>(TargetCodeGenInfo::getABIInfo());
5424   }
5425 
5426   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
5427     return 13;
5428   }
5429 
5430   StringRef getARCRetainAutoreleasedReturnValueMarker() const override {
5431     return "mov\tr7, r7\t\t@ marker for objc_retainAutoreleaseReturnValue";
5432   }
5433 
5434   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
5435                                llvm::Value *Address) const override {
5436     llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4);
5437 
5438     // 0-15 are the 16 integer registers.
5439     AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 15);
5440     return false;
5441   }
5442 
5443   unsigned getSizeOfUnwindException() const override {
5444     if (getABIInfo().isEABI()) return 88;
5445     return TargetCodeGenInfo::getSizeOfUnwindException();
5446   }
5447 
5448   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
5449                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
5450     const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
5451     if (!FD)
5452       return;
5453 
5454     const ARMInterruptAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>();
5455     if (!Attr)
5456       return;
5457 
5458     const char *Kind;
5459     switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) {
5460     case ARMInterruptAttr::Generic: Kind = ""; break;
5461     case ARMInterruptAttr::IRQ:     Kind = "IRQ"; break;
5462     case ARMInterruptAttr::FIQ:     Kind = "FIQ"; break;
5463     case ARMInterruptAttr::SWI:     Kind = "SWI"; break;
5464     case ARMInterruptAttr::ABORT:   Kind = "ABORT"; break;
5465     case ARMInterruptAttr::UNDEF:   Kind = "UNDEF"; break;
5466     }
5467 
5468     llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
5469 
5470     Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind);
5471 
5472     ARMABIInfo::ABIKind ABI = cast<ARMABIInfo>(getABIInfo()).getABIKind();
5473     if (ABI == ARMABIInfo::APCS)
5474       return;
5475 
5476     // AAPCS guarantees that sp will be 8-byte aligned on any public interface,
5477     // however this is not necessarily true on taking any interrupt. Instruct
5478     // the backend to perform a realignment as part of the function prologue.
5479     llvm::AttrBuilder B;
5480     B.addStackAlignmentAttr(8);
5481     Fn->addAttributes(llvm::AttributeList::FunctionIndex, B);
5482   }
5483 };
5484 
5485 class WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo : public ARMTargetCodeGenInfo {
5486 public:
5487   WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, ARMABIInfo::ABIKind K)
5488       : ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT, K) {}
5489 
5490   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
5491                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override;
5492 
5493   void getDependentLibraryOption(llvm::StringRef Lib,
5494                                  llvm::SmallString<24> &Opt) const override {
5495     Opt = "/DEFAULTLIB:" + qualifyWindowsLibrary(Lib);
5496   }
5497 
5498   void getDetectMismatchOption(llvm::StringRef Name, llvm::StringRef Value,
5499                                llvm::SmallString<32> &Opt) const override {
5500     Opt = "/FAILIFMISMATCH:\"" + Name.str() + "=" + Value.str() + "\"";
5501   }
5502 };
5503 
5504 void WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
5505     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
5506   ARMTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(D, GV, CGM);
5507   addStackProbeSizeTargetAttribute(D, GV, CGM);
5508 }
5509 }
5510 
5511 void ARMABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
5512   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
5513     FI.getReturnInfo() =
5514         classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType(), FI.isVariadic());
5515 
5516   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
5517     I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, FI.isVariadic());
5518 
5519   // Always honor user-specified calling convention.
5520   if (FI.getCallingConvention() != llvm::CallingConv::C)
5521     return;
5522 
5523   llvm::CallingConv::ID cc = getRuntimeCC();
5524   if (cc != llvm::CallingConv::C)
5525     FI.setEffectiveCallingConvention(cc);
5526 }
5527 
5528 /// Return the default calling convention that LLVM will use.
5529 llvm::CallingConv::ID ARMABIInfo::getLLVMDefaultCC() const {
5530   // The default calling convention that LLVM will infer.
5531   if (isEABIHF() || getTarget().getTriple().isWatchABI())
5532     return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP;
5533   else if (isEABI())
5534     return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS;
5535   else
5536     return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_APCS;
5537 }
5538 
5539 /// Return the calling convention that our ABI would like us to use
5540 /// as the C calling convention.
5541 llvm::CallingConv::ID ARMABIInfo::getABIDefaultCC() const {
5542   switch (getABIKind()) {
5543   case APCS: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_APCS;
5544   case AAPCS: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS;
5545   case AAPCS_VFP: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP;
5546   case AAPCS16_VFP: return llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS_VFP;
5547   }
5548   llvm_unreachable("bad ABI kind");
5549 }
5550 
5551 void ARMABIInfo::setCCs() {
5552   assert(getRuntimeCC() == llvm::CallingConv::C);
5553 
5554   // Don't muddy up the IR with a ton of explicit annotations if
5555   // they'd just match what LLVM will infer from the triple.
5556   llvm::CallingConv::ID abiCC = getABIDefaultCC();
5557   if (abiCC != getLLVMDefaultCC())
5558     RuntimeCC = abiCC;
5559 
5560   // AAPCS apparently requires runtime support functions to be soft-float, but
5561   // that's almost certainly for historic reasons (Thumb1 not supporting VFP
5562   // most likely). It's more convenient for AAPCS16_VFP to be hard-float.
5563   switch (getABIKind()) {
5564   case APCS:
5565   case AAPCS16_VFP:
5566     if (abiCC != getLLVMDefaultCC())
5567       BuiltinCC = abiCC;
5568     break;
5569   case AAPCS:
5570   case AAPCS_VFP:
5571     BuiltinCC = llvm::CallingConv::ARM_AAPCS;
5572     break;
5573   }
5574 }
5575 
5576 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty,
5577                                             bool isVariadic) const {
5578   // 6.1.2.1 The following argument types are VFP CPRCs:
5579   //   A single-precision floating-point type (including promoted
5580   //   half-precision types); A double-precision floating-point type;
5581   //   A 64-bit or 128-bit containerized vector type; Homogeneous Aggregate
5582   //   with a Base Type of a single- or double-precision floating-point type,
5583   //   64-bit containerized vectors or 128-bit containerized vectors with one
5584   //   to four Elements.
5585   bool IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP = getABIKind() == AAPCS_VFP && !isVariadic;
5586 
5587   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
5588 
5589   // Handle illegal vector types here.
5590   if (isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) {
5591     uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
5592     if (Size <= 32) {
5593       llvm::Type *ResType =
5594           llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
5595       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
5596     }
5597     if (Size == 64) {
5598       llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::VectorType::get(
5599           llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 2);
5600       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
5601     }
5602     if (Size == 128) {
5603       llvm::Type *ResType = llvm::VectorType::get(
5604           llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()), 4);
5605       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
5606     }
5607     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
5608   }
5609 
5610   // __fp16 gets passed as if it were an int or float, but with the top 16 bits
5611   // unspecified. This is not done for OpenCL as it handles the half type
5612   // natively, and does not need to interwork with AAPCS code.
5613   if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getContext().getLangOpts().NativeHalfArgsAndReturns) {
5614     llvm::Type *ResType = IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP ?
5615       llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()) :
5616       llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
5617     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
5618   }
5619 
5620   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
5621     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
5622     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>()) {
5623       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
5624     }
5625 
5626     return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend()
5627                                           : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
5628   }
5629 
5630   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) {
5631     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
5632   }
5633 
5634   // Ignore empty records.
5635   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
5636     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
5637 
5638   if (IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP) {
5639     // Homogeneous Aggregates need to be expanded when we can fit the aggregate
5640     // into VFP registers.
5641     const Type *Base = nullptr;
5642     uint64_t Members = 0;
5643     if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) {
5644       assert(Base && "Base class should be set for homogeneous aggregate");
5645       // Base can be a floating-point or a vector.
5646       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false);
5647     }
5648   } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP) {
5649     // WatchOS does have homogeneous aggregates. Note that we intentionally use
5650     // this convention even for a variadic function: the backend will use GPRs
5651     // if needed.
5652     const Type *Base = nullptr;
5653     uint64_t Members = 0;
5654     if (isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) {
5655       assert(Base && Members <= 4 && "unexpected homogeneous aggregate");
5656       llvm::Type *Ty =
5657         llvm::ArrayType::get(CGT.ConvertType(QualType(Base, 0)), Members);
5658       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(Ty, 0, nullptr, false);
5659     }
5660   }
5661 
5662   if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP &&
5663       getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16)) {
5664     // WatchOS is adopting the 64-bit AAPCS rule on composite types: if they're
5665     // bigger than 128-bits, they get placed in space allocated by the caller,
5666     // and a pointer is passed.
5667     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(
5668         CharUnits::fromQuantity(getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8), false);
5669   }
5670 
5671   // Support byval for ARM.
5672   // The ABI alignment for APCS is 4-byte and for AAPCS at least 4-byte and at
5673   // most 8-byte. We realign the indirect argument if type alignment is bigger
5674   // than ABI alignment.
5675   uint64_t ABIAlign = 4;
5676   uint64_t TyAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8;
5677   if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP ||
5678        getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS)
5679     ABIAlign = std::min(std::max(TyAlign, (uint64_t)4), (uint64_t)8);
5680 
5681   if (getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(64)) {
5682     assert(getABIKind() != ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP && "unexpected byval");
5683     return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(ABIAlign),
5684                                    /*ByVal=*/true,
5685                                    /*Realign=*/TyAlign > ABIAlign);
5686   }
5687 
5688   // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 64 bytes to an integer array of
5689   // same size and alignment.
5690   if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) {
5691     return coerceToIntArray(Ty, getContext(), getVMContext());
5692   }
5693 
5694   // Otherwise, pass by coercing to a structure of the appropriate size.
5695   llvm::Type* ElemTy;
5696   unsigned SizeRegs;
5697   // FIXME: Try to match the types of the arguments more accurately where
5698   // we can.
5699   if (getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) <= 32) {
5700     ElemTy = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
5701     SizeRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32;
5702   } else {
5703     ElemTy = llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext());
5704     SizeRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 63) / 64;
5705   }
5706 
5707   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::ArrayType::get(ElemTy, SizeRegs));
5708 }
5709 
5710 static bool isIntegerLikeType(QualType Ty, ASTContext &Context,
5711                               llvm::LLVMContext &VMContext) {
5712   // APCS, C Language Calling Conventions, Non-Simple Return Values: A structure
5713   // is called integer-like if its size is less than or equal to one word, and
5714   // the offset of each of its addressable sub-fields is zero.
5715 
5716   uint64_t Size = Context.getTypeSize(Ty);
5717 
5718   // Check that the type fits in a word.
5719   if (Size > 32)
5720     return false;
5721 
5722   // FIXME: Handle vector types!
5723   if (Ty->isVectorType())
5724     return false;
5725 
5726   // Float types are never treated as "integer like".
5727   if (Ty->isRealFloatingType())
5728     return false;
5729 
5730   // If this is a builtin or pointer type then it is ok.
5731   if (Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>() || Ty->isPointerType())
5732     return true;
5733 
5734   // Small complex integer types are "integer like".
5735   if (const ComplexType *CT = Ty->getAs<ComplexType>())
5736     return isIntegerLikeType(CT->getElementType(), Context, VMContext);
5737 
5738   // Single element and zero sized arrays should be allowed, by the definition
5739   // above, but they are not.
5740 
5741   // Otherwise, it must be a record type.
5742   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
5743   if (!RT) return false;
5744 
5745   // Ignore records with flexible arrays.
5746   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
5747   if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
5748     return false;
5749 
5750   // Check that all sub-fields are at offset 0, and are themselves "integer
5751   // like".
5752   const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = Context.getASTRecordLayout(RD);
5753 
5754   bool HadField = false;
5755   unsigned idx = 0;
5756   for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end();
5757        i != e; ++i, ++idx) {
5758     const FieldDecl *FD = *i;
5759 
5760     // Bit-fields are not addressable, we only need to verify they are "integer
5761     // like". We still have to disallow a subsequent non-bitfield, for example:
5762     //   struct { int : 0; int x }
5763     // is non-integer like according to gcc.
5764     if (FD->isBitField()) {
5765       if (!RD->isUnion())
5766         HadField = true;
5767 
5768       if (!isIntegerLikeType(FD->getType(), Context, VMContext))
5769         return false;
5770 
5771       continue;
5772     }
5773 
5774     // Check if this field is at offset 0.
5775     if (Layout.getFieldOffset(idx) != 0)
5776       return false;
5777 
5778     if (!isIntegerLikeType(FD->getType(), Context, VMContext))
5779       return false;
5780 
5781     // Only allow at most one field in a structure. This doesn't match the
5782     // wording above, but follows gcc in situations with a field following an
5783     // empty structure.
5784     if (!RD->isUnion()) {
5785       if (HadField)
5786         return false;
5787 
5788       HadField = true;
5789     }
5790   }
5791 
5792   return true;
5793 }
5794 
5795 ABIArgInfo ARMABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy,
5796                                           bool isVariadic) const {
5797   bool IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP =
5798       (getABIKind() == AAPCS_VFP || getABIKind() == AAPCS16_VFP) && !isVariadic;
5799 
5800   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
5801     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
5802 
5803   // Large vector types should be returned via memory.
5804   if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 128) {
5805     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
5806   }
5807 
5808   // __fp16 gets returned as if it were an int or float, but with the top 16
5809   // bits unspecified. This is not done for OpenCL as it handles the half type
5810   // natively, and does not need to interwork with AAPCS code.
5811   if (RetTy->isHalfType() && !getContext().getLangOpts().NativeHalfArgsAndReturns) {
5812     llvm::Type *ResType = IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP ?
5813       llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext()) :
5814       llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
5815     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(ResType);
5816   }
5817 
5818   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
5819     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
5820     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
5821       RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
5822 
5823     return RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ? ABIArgInfo::getExtend()
5824                                             : ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
5825   }
5826 
5827   // Are we following APCS?
5828   if (getABIKind() == APCS) {
5829     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, false))
5830       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
5831 
5832     // Complex types are all returned as packed integers.
5833     //
5834     // FIXME: Consider using 2 x vector types if the back end handles them
5835     // correctly.
5836     if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
5837       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::IntegerType::get(
5838           getVMContext(), getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy)));
5839 
5840     // Integer like structures are returned in r0.
5841     if (isIntegerLikeType(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext())) {
5842       // Return in the smallest viable integer type.
5843       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
5844       if (Size <= 8)
5845         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()));
5846       if (Size <= 16)
5847         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()));
5848       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()));
5849     }
5850 
5851     // Otherwise return in memory.
5852     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
5853   }
5854 
5855   // Otherwise this is an AAPCS variant.
5856 
5857   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true))
5858     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
5859 
5860   // Check for homogeneous aggregates with AAPCS-VFP.
5861   if (IsEffectivelyAAPCS_VFP) {
5862     const Type *Base = nullptr;
5863     uint64_t Members = 0;
5864     if (isHomogeneousAggregate(RetTy, Base, Members)) {
5865       assert(Base && "Base class should be set for homogeneous aggregate");
5866       // Homogeneous Aggregates are returned directly.
5867       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false);
5868     }
5869   }
5870 
5871   // Aggregates <= 4 bytes are returned in r0; other aggregates
5872   // are returned indirectly.
5873   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
5874   if (Size <= 32) {
5875     // On RenderScript, coerce Aggregates <= 4 bytes to an integer array of
5876     // same size and alignment.
5877     if (getTarget().isRenderScriptTarget()) {
5878       return coerceToIntArray(RetTy, getContext(), getVMContext());
5879     }
5880     if (getDataLayout().isBigEndian())
5881       // Return in 32 bit integer integer type (as if loaded by LDR, AAPCS 5.4)
5882       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()));
5883 
5884     // Return in the smallest viable integer type.
5885     if (Size <= 8)
5886       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()));
5887     if (Size <= 16)
5888       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()));
5889     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()));
5890   } else if (Size <= 128 && getABIKind() == AAPCS16_VFP) {
5891     llvm::Type *Int32Ty = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext());
5892     llvm::Type *CoerceTy =
5893         llvm::ArrayType::get(Int32Ty, llvm::alignTo(Size, 32) / 32);
5894     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
5895   }
5896 
5897   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
5898 }
5899 
5900 /// isIllegalVector - check whether Ty is an illegal vector type.
5901 bool ARMABIInfo::isIllegalVectorType(QualType Ty) const {
5902   if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType> ()) {
5903     if (isAndroid()) {
5904       // Android shipped using Clang 3.1, which supported a slightly different
5905       // vector ABI. The primary differences were that 3-element vector types
5906       // were legal, and so were sub 32-bit vectors (i.e. <2 x i8>). This path
5907       // accepts that legacy behavior for Android only.
5908       // Check whether VT is legal.
5909       unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements();
5910       // NumElements should be power of 2 or equal to 3.
5911       if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements) && NumElements != 3)
5912         return true;
5913     } else {
5914       // Check whether VT is legal.
5915       unsigned NumElements = VT->getNumElements();
5916       uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
5917       // NumElements should be power of 2.
5918       if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(NumElements))
5919         return true;
5920       // Size should be greater than 32 bits.
5921       return Size <= 32;
5922     }
5923   }
5924   return false;
5925 }
5926 
5927 bool ARMABIInfo::isLegalVectorTypeForSwift(CharUnits vectorSize,
5928                                            llvm::Type *eltTy,
5929                                            unsigned numElts) const {
5930   if (!llvm::isPowerOf2_32(numElts))
5931     return false;
5932   unsigned size = getDataLayout().getTypeStoreSizeInBits(eltTy);
5933   if (size > 64)
5934     return false;
5935   if (vectorSize.getQuantity() != 8 &&
5936       (vectorSize.getQuantity() != 16 || numElts == 1))
5937     return false;
5938   return true;
5939 }
5940 
5941 bool ARMABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateBaseType(QualType Ty) const {
5942   // Homogeneous aggregates for AAPCS-VFP must have base types of float,
5943   // double, or 64-bit or 128-bit vectors.
5944   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
5945     if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
5946         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double ||
5947         BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble)
5948       return true;
5949   } else if (const VectorType *VT = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()) {
5950     unsigned VecSize = getContext().getTypeSize(VT);
5951     if (VecSize == 64 || VecSize == 128)
5952       return true;
5953   }
5954   return false;
5955 }
5956 
5957 bool ARMABIInfo::isHomogeneousAggregateSmallEnough(const Type *Base,
5958                                                    uint64_t Members) const {
5959   return Members <= 4;
5960 }
5961 
5962 Address ARMABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
5963                               QualType Ty) const {
5964   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
5965 
5966   // Empty records are ignored for parameter passing purposes.
5967   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true)) {
5968     Address Addr(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize);
5969     Addr = CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty));
5970     return Addr;
5971   }
5972 
5973   auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
5974   CharUnits TyAlignForABI = TyInfo.second;
5975 
5976   // Use indirect if size of the illegal vector is bigger than 16 bytes.
5977   bool IsIndirect = false;
5978   const Type *Base = nullptr;
5979   uint64_t Members = 0;
5980   if (TyInfo.first > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16) && isIllegalVectorType(Ty)) {
5981     IsIndirect = true;
5982 
5983   // ARMv7k passes structs bigger than 16 bytes indirectly, in space
5984   // allocated by the caller.
5985   } else if (TyInfo.first > CharUnits::fromQuantity(16) &&
5986              getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP &&
5987              !isHomogeneousAggregate(Ty, Base, Members)) {
5988     IsIndirect = true;
5989 
5990   // Otherwise, bound the type's ABI alignment.
5991   // The ABI alignment for 64-bit or 128-bit vectors is 8 for AAPCS and 4 for
5992   // APCS. For AAPCS, the ABI alignment is at least 4-byte and at most 8-byte.
5993   // Our callers should be prepared to handle an under-aligned address.
5994   } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP ||
5995              getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS) {
5996     TyAlignForABI = std::max(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4));
5997     TyAlignForABI = std::min(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(8));
5998   } else if (getABIKind() == ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP) {
5999     // ARMv7k allows type alignment up to 16 bytes.
6000     TyAlignForABI = std::max(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(4));
6001     TyAlignForABI = std::min(TyAlignForABI, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16));
6002   } else {
6003     TyAlignForABI = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
6004   }
6005   TyInfo.second = TyAlignForABI;
6006 
6007   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, IsIndirect, TyInfo,
6008                           SlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true);
6009 }
6010 
6011 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6012 // NVPTX ABI Implementation
6013 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6014 
6015 namespace {
6016 
6017 class NVPTXABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
6018 public:
6019   NVPTXABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {}
6020 
6021   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
6022   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
6023 
6024   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
6025   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
6026                     QualType Ty) const override;
6027 };
6028 
6029 class NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
6030 public:
6031   NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
6032     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new NVPTXABIInfo(CGT)) {}
6033 
6034   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
6035                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override;
6036 private:
6037   // Adds a NamedMDNode with F, Name, and Operand as operands, and adds the
6038   // resulting MDNode to the nvvm.annotations MDNode.
6039   static void addNVVMMetadata(llvm::Function *F, StringRef Name, int Operand);
6040 };
6041 
6042 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
6043   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
6044     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
6045 
6046   // note: this is different from default ABI
6047   if (!RetTy->isScalarType())
6048     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
6049 
6050   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
6051   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
6052     RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6053 
6054   return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
6055           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
6056 }
6057 
6058 ABIArgInfo NVPTXABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
6059   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
6060   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
6061     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6062 
6063   // Return aggregates type as indirect by value
6064   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty))
6065     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /* byval */ true);
6066 
6067   return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
6068           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
6069 }
6070 
6071 void NVPTXABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
6072   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
6073     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
6074   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
6075     I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
6076 
6077   // Always honor user-specified calling convention.
6078   if (FI.getCallingConvention() != llvm::CallingConv::C)
6079     return;
6080 
6081   FI.setEffectiveCallingConvention(getRuntimeCC());
6082 }
6083 
6084 Address NVPTXABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
6085                                 QualType Ty) const {
6086   llvm_unreachable("NVPTX does not support varargs");
6087 }
6088 
6089 void NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo::
6090 setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
6091                     CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const{
6092   const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
6093   if (!FD) return;
6094 
6095   llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
6096 
6097   // Perform special handling in OpenCL mode
6098   if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
6099     // Use OpenCL function attributes to check for kernel functions
6100     // By default, all functions are device functions
6101     if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
6102       // OpenCL __kernel functions get kernel metadata
6103       // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"kernel", i32 1} node
6104       addNVVMMetadata(F, "kernel", 1);
6105       // And kernel functions are not subject to inlining
6106       F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline);
6107     }
6108   }
6109 
6110   // Perform special handling in CUDA mode.
6111   if (M.getLangOpts().CUDA) {
6112     // CUDA __global__ functions get a kernel metadata entry.  Since
6113     // __global__ functions cannot be called from the device, we do not
6114     // need to set the noinline attribute.
6115     if (FD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) {
6116       // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"kernel", i32 1} node
6117       addNVVMMetadata(F, "kernel", 1);
6118     }
6119     if (CUDALaunchBoundsAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<CUDALaunchBoundsAttr>()) {
6120       // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"maxntidx", i32 <val>} node
6121       llvm::APSInt MaxThreads(32);
6122       MaxThreads = Attr->getMaxThreads()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext());
6123       if (MaxThreads > 0)
6124         addNVVMMetadata(F, "maxntidx", MaxThreads.getExtValue());
6125 
6126       // min blocks is an optional argument for CUDALaunchBoundsAttr. If it was
6127       // not specified in __launch_bounds__ or if the user specified a 0 value,
6128       // we don't have to add a PTX directive.
6129       if (Attr->getMinBlocks()) {
6130         llvm::APSInt MinBlocks(32);
6131         MinBlocks = Attr->getMinBlocks()->EvaluateKnownConstInt(M.getContext());
6132         if (MinBlocks > 0)
6133           // Create !{<func-ref>, metadata !"minctasm", i32 <val>} node
6134           addNVVMMetadata(F, "minctasm", MinBlocks.getExtValue());
6135       }
6136     }
6137   }
6138 }
6139 
6140 void NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo::addNVVMMetadata(llvm::Function *F, StringRef Name,
6141                                              int Operand) {
6142   llvm::Module *M = F->getParent();
6143   llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = M->getContext();
6144 
6145   // Get "nvvm.annotations" metadata node
6146   llvm::NamedMDNode *MD = M->getOrInsertNamedMetadata("nvvm.annotations");
6147 
6148   llvm::Metadata *MDVals[] = {
6149       llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(F), llvm::MDString::get(Ctx, Name),
6150       llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(
6151           llvm::ConstantInt::get(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(Ctx), Operand))};
6152   // Append metadata to nvvm.annotations
6153   MD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, MDVals));
6154 }
6155 }
6156 
6157 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6158 // SystemZ ABI Implementation
6159 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6160 
6161 namespace {
6162 
6163 class SystemZABIInfo : public SwiftABIInfo {
6164   bool HasVector;
6165 
6166 public:
6167   SystemZABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool HV)
6168     : SwiftABIInfo(CGT), HasVector(HV) {}
6169 
6170   bool isPromotableIntegerType(QualType Ty) const;
6171   bool isCompoundType(QualType Ty) const;
6172   bool isVectorArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
6173   bool isFPArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
6174   QualType GetSingleElementType(QualType Ty) const;
6175 
6176   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
6177   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType ArgTy) const;
6178 
6179   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
6180     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
6181       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
6182     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
6183       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
6184   }
6185 
6186   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
6187                     QualType Ty) const override;
6188 
6189   bool shouldPassIndirectlyForSwift(CharUnits totalSize,
6190                                     ArrayRef<llvm::Type*> scalars,
6191                                     bool asReturnValue) const override {
6192     return occupiesMoreThan(CGT, scalars, /*total*/ 4);
6193   }
6194   bool isSwiftErrorInRegister() const override {
6195     return true;
6196   }
6197 };
6198 
6199 class SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
6200 public:
6201   SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool HasVector)
6202     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SystemZABIInfo(CGT, HasVector)) {}
6203 };
6204 
6205 }
6206 
6207 bool SystemZABIInfo::isPromotableIntegerType(QualType Ty) const {
6208   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
6209   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
6210     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6211 
6212   // Promotable integer types are required to be promoted by the ABI.
6213   if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType())
6214     return true;
6215 
6216   // 32-bit values must also be promoted.
6217   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
6218     switch (BT->getKind()) {
6219     case BuiltinType::Int:
6220     case BuiltinType::UInt:
6221       return true;
6222     default:
6223       return false;
6224     }
6225   return false;
6226 }
6227 
6228 bool SystemZABIInfo::isCompoundType(QualType Ty) const {
6229   return (Ty->isAnyComplexType() ||
6230           Ty->isVectorType() ||
6231           isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty));
6232 }
6233 
6234 bool SystemZABIInfo::isVectorArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
6235   return (HasVector &&
6236           Ty->isVectorType() &&
6237           getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) <= 128);
6238 }
6239 
6240 bool SystemZABIInfo::isFPArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
6241   if (const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>())
6242     switch (BT->getKind()) {
6243     case BuiltinType::Float:
6244     case BuiltinType::Double:
6245       return true;
6246     default:
6247       return false;
6248     }
6249 
6250   return false;
6251 }
6252 
6253 QualType SystemZABIInfo::GetSingleElementType(QualType Ty) const {
6254   if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAsStructureType()) {
6255     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
6256     QualType Found;
6257 
6258     // If this is a C++ record, check the bases first.
6259     if (const CXXRecordDecl *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD))
6260       for (const auto &I : CXXRD->bases()) {
6261         QualType Base = I.getType();
6262 
6263         // Empty bases don't affect things either way.
6264         if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Base, true))
6265           continue;
6266 
6267         if (!Found.isNull())
6268           return Ty;
6269         Found = GetSingleElementType(Base);
6270       }
6271 
6272     // Check the fields.
6273     for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
6274       // For compatibility with GCC, ignore empty bitfields in C++ mode.
6275       // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), empty structure and array fields
6276       // do count.  So do anonymous bitfields that aren't zero-sized.
6277       if (getContext().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
6278           FD->isBitField() && FD->getBitWidthValue(getContext()) == 0)
6279         continue;
6280 
6281       // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), arrays do not count.
6282       // Nested structures still do though.
6283       if (!Found.isNull())
6284         return Ty;
6285       Found = GetSingleElementType(FD->getType());
6286     }
6287 
6288     // Unlike isSingleElementStruct(), trailing padding is allowed.
6289     // An 8-byte aligned struct s { float f; } is passed as a double.
6290     if (!Found.isNull())
6291       return Found;
6292   }
6293 
6294   return Ty;
6295 }
6296 
6297 Address SystemZABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
6298                                   QualType Ty) const {
6299   // Assume that va_list type is correct; should be pointer to LLVM type:
6300   // struct {
6301   //   i64 __gpr;
6302   //   i64 __fpr;
6303   //   i8 *__overflow_arg_area;
6304   //   i8 *__reg_save_area;
6305   // };
6306 
6307   // Every non-vector argument occupies 8 bytes and is passed by preference
6308   // in either GPRs or FPRs.  Vector arguments occupy 8 or 16 bytes and are
6309   // always passed on the stack.
6310   Ty = getContext().getCanonicalType(Ty);
6311   auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
6312   llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGF.ConvertTypeForMem(Ty);
6313   llvm::Type *DirectTy = ArgTy;
6314   ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty);
6315   bool IsIndirect = AI.isIndirect();
6316   bool InFPRs = false;
6317   bool IsVector = false;
6318   CharUnits UnpaddedSize;
6319   CharUnits DirectAlign;
6320   if (IsIndirect) {
6321     DirectTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(DirectTy);
6322     UnpaddedSize = DirectAlign = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
6323   } else {
6324     if (AI.getCoerceToType())
6325       ArgTy = AI.getCoerceToType();
6326     InFPRs = ArgTy->isFloatTy() || ArgTy->isDoubleTy();
6327     IsVector = ArgTy->isVectorTy();
6328     UnpaddedSize = TyInfo.first;
6329     DirectAlign = TyInfo.second;
6330   }
6331   CharUnits PaddedSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
6332   if (IsVector && UnpaddedSize > PaddedSize)
6333     PaddedSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(16);
6334   assert((UnpaddedSize <= PaddedSize) && "Invalid argument size.");
6335 
6336   CharUnits Padding = (PaddedSize - UnpaddedSize);
6337 
6338   llvm::Type *IndexTy = CGF.Int64Ty;
6339   llvm::Value *PaddedSizeV =
6340     llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, PaddedSize.getQuantity());
6341 
6342   if (IsVector) {
6343     // Work out the address of a vector argument on the stack.
6344     // Vector arguments are always passed in the high bits of a
6345     // single (8 byte) or double (16 byte) stack slot.
6346     Address OverflowArgAreaPtr =
6347       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 2, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16),
6348                                   "overflow_arg_area_ptr");
6349     Address OverflowArgArea =
6350       Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowArgAreaPtr, "overflow_arg_area"),
6351               TyInfo.second);
6352     Address MemAddr =
6353       CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(OverflowArgArea, DirectTy, "mem_addr");
6354 
6355     // Update overflow_arg_area_ptr pointer
6356     llvm::Value *NewOverflowArgArea =
6357       CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(OverflowArgArea.getPointer(), PaddedSizeV,
6358                             "overflow_arg_area");
6359     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOverflowArgArea, OverflowArgAreaPtr);
6360 
6361     return MemAddr;
6362   }
6363 
6364   assert(PaddedSize.getQuantity() == 8);
6365 
6366   unsigned MaxRegs, RegCountField, RegSaveIndex;
6367   CharUnits RegPadding;
6368   if (InFPRs) {
6369     MaxRegs = 4; // Maximum of 4 FPR arguments
6370     RegCountField = 1; // __fpr
6371     RegSaveIndex = 16; // save offset for f0
6372     RegPadding = CharUnits(); // floats are passed in the high bits of an FPR
6373   } else {
6374     MaxRegs = 5; // Maximum of 5 GPR arguments
6375     RegCountField = 0; // __gpr
6376     RegSaveIndex = 2; // save offset for r2
6377     RegPadding = Padding; // values are passed in the low bits of a GPR
6378   }
6379 
6380   Address RegCountPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(
6381       VAListAddr, RegCountField, RegCountField * CharUnits::fromQuantity(8),
6382       "reg_count_ptr");
6383   llvm::Value *RegCount = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RegCountPtr, "reg_count");
6384   llvm::Value *MaxRegsV = llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, MaxRegs);
6385   llvm::Value *InRegs = CGF.Builder.CreateICmpULT(RegCount, MaxRegsV,
6386                                                  "fits_in_regs");
6387 
6388   llvm::BasicBlock *InRegBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_reg");
6389   llvm::BasicBlock *InMemBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.in_mem");
6390   llvm::BasicBlock *ContBlock = CGF.createBasicBlock("vaarg.end");
6391   CGF.Builder.CreateCondBr(InRegs, InRegBlock, InMemBlock);
6392 
6393   // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in registers.
6394   CGF.EmitBlock(InRegBlock);
6395 
6396   // Work out the address of an argument register.
6397   llvm::Value *ScaledRegCount =
6398     CGF.Builder.CreateMul(RegCount, PaddedSizeV, "scaled_reg_count");
6399   llvm::Value *RegBase =
6400     llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, RegSaveIndex * PaddedSize.getQuantity()
6401                                       + RegPadding.getQuantity());
6402   llvm::Value *RegOffset =
6403     CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(ScaledRegCount, RegBase, "reg_offset");
6404   Address RegSaveAreaPtr =
6405       CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(VAListAddr, 3, CharUnits::fromQuantity(24),
6406                                   "reg_save_area_ptr");
6407   llvm::Value *RegSaveArea =
6408     CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(RegSaveAreaPtr, "reg_save_area");
6409   Address RawRegAddr(CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(RegSaveArea, RegOffset,
6410                                            "raw_reg_addr"),
6411                      PaddedSize);
6412   Address RegAddr =
6413     CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RawRegAddr, DirectTy, "reg_addr");
6414 
6415   // Update the register count
6416   llvm::Value *One = llvm::ConstantInt::get(IndexTy, 1);
6417   llvm::Value *NewRegCount =
6418     CGF.Builder.CreateAdd(RegCount, One, "reg_count");
6419   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewRegCount, RegCountPtr);
6420   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
6421 
6422   // Emit code to load the value if it was passed in memory.
6423   CGF.EmitBlock(InMemBlock);
6424 
6425   // Work out the address of a stack argument.
6426   Address OverflowArgAreaPtr = CGF.Builder.CreateStructGEP(
6427       VAListAddr, 2, CharUnits::fromQuantity(16), "overflow_arg_area_ptr");
6428   Address OverflowArgArea =
6429     Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(OverflowArgAreaPtr, "overflow_arg_area"),
6430             PaddedSize);
6431   Address RawMemAddr =
6432     CGF.Builder.CreateConstByteGEP(OverflowArgArea, Padding, "raw_mem_addr");
6433   Address MemAddr =
6434     CGF.Builder.CreateElementBitCast(RawMemAddr, DirectTy, "mem_addr");
6435 
6436   // Update overflow_arg_area_ptr pointer
6437   llvm::Value *NewOverflowArgArea =
6438     CGF.Builder.CreateGEP(OverflowArgArea.getPointer(), PaddedSizeV,
6439                           "overflow_arg_area");
6440   CGF.Builder.CreateStore(NewOverflowArgArea, OverflowArgAreaPtr);
6441   CGF.EmitBranch(ContBlock);
6442 
6443   // Return the appropriate result.
6444   CGF.EmitBlock(ContBlock);
6445   Address ResAddr = emitMergePHI(CGF, RegAddr, InRegBlock,
6446                                  MemAddr, InMemBlock, "va_arg.addr");
6447 
6448   if (IsIndirect)
6449     ResAddr = Address(CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(ResAddr, "indirect_arg"),
6450                       TyInfo.second);
6451 
6452   return ResAddr;
6453 }
6454 
6455 ABIArgInfo SystemZABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
6456   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
6457     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
6458   if (isVectorArgumentType(RetTy))
6459     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
6460   if (isCompoundType(RetTy) || getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 64)
6461     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
6462   return (isPromotableIntegerType(RetTy) ?
6463           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
6464 }
6465 
6466 ABIArgInfo SystemZABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
6467   // Handle the generic C++ ABI.
6468   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
6469     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
6470 
6471   // Integers and enums are extended to full register width.
6472   if (isPromotableIntegerType(Ty))
6473     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend();
6474 
6475   // Handle vector types and vector-like structure types.  Note that
6476   // as opposed to float-like structure types, we do not allow any
6477   // padding for vector-like structures, so verify the sizes match.
6478   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
6479   QualType SingleElementTy = GetSingleElementType(Ty);
6480   if (isVectorArgumentType(SingleElementTy) &&
6481       getContext().getTypeSize(SingleElementTy) == Size)
6482     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CGT.ConvertType(SingleElementTy));
6483 
6484   // Values that are not 1, 2, 4 or 8 bytes in size are passed indirectly.
6485   if (Size != 8 && Size != 16 && Size != 32 && Size != 64)
6486     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
6487 
6488   // Handle small structures.
6489   if (const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>()) {
6490     // Structures with flexible arrays have variable length, so really
6491     // fail the size test above.
6492     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
6493     if (RD->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
6494       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
6495 
6496     // The structure is passed as an unextended integer, a float, or a double.
6497     llvm::Type *PassTy;
6498     if (isFPArgumentType(SingleElementTy)) {
6499       assert(Size == 32 || Size == 64);
6500       if (Size == 32)
6501         PassTy = llvm::Type::getFloatTy(getVMContext());
6502       else
6503         PassTy = llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext());
6504     } else
6505       PassTy = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), Size);
6506     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(PassTy);
6507   }
6508 
6509   // Non-structure compounds are passed indirectly.
6510   if (isCompoundType(Ty))
6511     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
6512 
6513   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr);
6514 }
6515 
6516 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6517 // MSP430 ABI Implementation
6518 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6519 
6520 namespace {
6521 
6522 class MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
6523 public:
6524   MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
6525     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {}
6526   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
6527                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override;
6528 };
6529 
6530 }
6531 
6532 void MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D,
6533                                                   llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
6534                                              CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const {
6535   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
6536     if (const MSP430InterruptAttr *attr = FD->getAttr<MSP430InterruptAttr>()) {
6537       // Handle 'interrupt' attribute:
6538       llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
6539 
6540       // Step 1: Set ISR calling convention.
6541       F->setCallingConv(llvm::CallingConv::MSP430_INTR);
6542 
6543       // Step 2: Add attributes goodness.
6544       F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline);
6545 
6546       // Step 3: Emit ISR vector alias.
6547       unsigned Num = attr->getNumber() / 2;
6548       llvm::GlobalAlias::create(llvm::Function::ExternalLinkage,
6549                                 "__isr_" + Twine(Num), F);
6550     }
6551   }
6552 }
6553 
6554 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6555 // MIPS ABI Implementation.  This works for both little-endian and
6556 // big-endian variants.
6557 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6558 
6559 namespace {
6560 class MipsABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
6561   bool IsO32;
6562   unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes, StackAlignInBytes;
6563   void CoerceToIntArgs(uint64_t TySize,
6564                        SmallVectorImpl<llvm::Type *> &ArgList) const;
6565   llvm::Type* HandleAggregates(QualType Ty, uint64_t TySize) const;
6566   llvm::Type* returnAggregateInRegs(QualType RetTy, uint64_t Size) const;
6567   llvm::Type* getPaddingType(uint64_t Align, uint64_t Offset) const;
6568 public:
6569   MipsABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool _IsO32) :
6570     ABIInfo(CGT), IsO32(_IsO32), MinABIStackAlignInBytes(IsO32 ? 4 : 8),
6571     StackAlignInBytes(IsO32 ? 8 : 16) {}
6572 
6573   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
6574   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, uint64_t &Offset) const;
6575   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
6576   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
6577                     QualType Ty) const override;
6578   bool shouldSignExtUnsignedType(QualType Ty) const override;
6579 };
6580 
6581 class MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
6582   unsigned SizeOfUnwindException;
6583 public:
6584   MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT, bool IsO32)
6585     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new MipsABIInfo(CGT, IsO32)),
6586       SizeOfUnwindException(IsO32 ? 24 : 32) {}
6587 
6588   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
6589     return 29;
6590   }
6591 
6592   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
6593                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
6594     const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
6595     if (!FD) return;
6596     llvm::Function *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
6597     if (FD->hasAttr<Mips16Attr>()) {
6598       Fn->addFnAttr("mips16");
6599     }
6600     else if (FD->hasAttr<NoMips16Attr>()) {
6601       Fn->addFnAttr("nomips16");
6602     }
6603 
6604     if (FD->hasAttr<MicroMipsAttr>())
6605       Fn->addFnAttr("micromips");
6606     else if (FD->hasAttr<NoMicroMipsAttr>())
6607       Fn->addFnAttr("nomicromips");
6608 
6609     const MipsInterruptAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<MipsInterruptAttr>();
6610     if (!Attr)
6611       return;
6612 
6613     const char *Kind;
6614     switch (Attr->getInterrupt()) {
6615     case MipsInterruptAttr::eic:     Kind = "eic"; break;
6616     case MipsInterruptAttr::sw0:     Kind = "sw0"; break;
6617     case MipsInterruptAttr::sw1:     Kind = "sw1"; break;
6618     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw0:     Kind = "hw0"; break;
6619     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw1:     Kind = "hw1"; break;
6620     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw2:     Kind = "hw2"; break;
6621     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw3:     Kind = "hw3"; break;
6622     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw4:     Kind = "hw4"; break;
6623     case MipsInterruptAttr::hw5:     Kind = "hw5"; break;
6624     }
6625 
6626     Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt", Kind);
6627 
6628   }
6629 
6630   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
6631                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
6632 
6633   unsigned getSizeOfUnwindException() const override {
6634     return SizeOfUnwindException;
6635   }
6636 };
6637 }
6638 
6639 void MipsABIInfo::CoerceToIntArgs(
6640     uint64_t TySize, SmallVectorImpl<llvm::Type *> &ArgList) const {
6641   llvm::IntegerType *IntTy =
6642     llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8);
6643 
6644   // Add (TySize / MinABIStackAlignInBytes) args of IntTy.
6645   for (unsigned N = TySize / (MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8); N; --N)
6646     ArgList.push_back(IntTy);
6647 
6648   // If necessary, add one more integer type to ArgList.
6649   unsigned R = TySize % (MinABIStackAlignInBytes * 8);
6650 
6651   if (R)
6652     ArgList.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), R));
6653 }
6654 
6655 // In N32/64, an aligned double precision floating point field is passed in
6656 // a register.
6657 llvm::Type* MipsABIInfo::HandleAggregates(QualType Ty, uint64_t TySize) const {
6658   SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> ArgList, IntArgList;
6659 
6660   if (IsO32) {
6661     CoerceToIntArgs(TySize, ArgList);
6662     return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList);
6663   }
6664 
6665   if (Ty->isComplexType())
6666     return CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
6667 
6668   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6669 
6670   // Unions/vectors are passed in integer registers.
6671   if (!RT || !RT->isStructureOrClassType()) {
6672     CoerceToIntArgs(TySize, ArgList);
6673     return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList);
6674   }
6675 
6676   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
6677   const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD);
6678   assert(!(TySize % 8) && "Size of structure must be multiple of 8.");
6679 
6680   uint64_t LastOffset = 0;
6681   unsigned idx = 0;
6682   llvm::IntegerType *I64 = llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), 64);
6683 
6684   // Iterate over fields in the struct/class and check if there are any aligned
6685   // double fields.
6686   for (RecordDecl::field_iterator i = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end();
6687        i != e; ++i, ++idx) {
6688     const QualType Ty = i->getType();
6689     const BuiltinType *BT = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>();
6690 
6691     if (!BT || BT->getKind() != BuiltinType::Double)
6692       continue;
6693 
6694     uint64_t Offset = Layout.getFieldOffset(idx);
6695     if (Offset % 64) // Ignore doubles that are not aligned.
6696       continue;
6697 
6698     // Add ((Offset - LastOffset) / 64) args of type i64.
6699     for (unsigned j = (Offset - LastOffset) / 64; j > 0; --j)
6700       ArgList.push_back(I64);
6701 
6702     // Add double type.
6703     ArgList.push_back(llvm::Type::getDoubleTy(getVMContext()));
6704     LastOffset = Offset + 64;
6705   }
6706 
6707   CoerceToIntArgs(TySize - LastOffset, IntArgList);
6708   ArgList.append(IntArgList.begin(), IntArgList.end());
6709 
6710   return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), ArgList);
6711 }
6712 
6713 llvm::Type *MipsABIInfo::getPaddingType(uint64_t OrigOffset,
6714                                         uint64_t Offset) const {
6715   if (OrigOffset + MinABIStackAlignInBytes > Offset)
6716     return nullptr;
6717 
6718   return llvm::IntegerType::get(getVMContext(), (Offset - OrigOffset) * 8);
6719 }
6720 
6721 ABIArgInfo
6722 MipsABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty, uint64_t &Offset) const {
6723   Ty = useFirstFieldIfTransparentUnion(Ty);
6724 
6725   uint64_t OrigOffset = Offset;
6726   uint64_t TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
6727   uint64_t Align = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8;
6728 
6729   Align = std::min(std::max(Align, (uint64_t)MinABIStackAlignInBytes),
6730                    (uint64_t)StackAlignInBytes);
6731   unsigned CurrOffset = llvm::alignTo(Offset, Align);
6732   Offset = CurrOffset + llvm::alignTo(TySize, Align * 8) / 8;
6733 
6734   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty) || Ty->isVectorType()) {
6735     // Ignore empty aggregates.
6736     if (TySize == 0)
6737       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
6738 
6739     if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI())) {
6740       Offset = OrigOffset + MinABIStackAlignInBytes;
6741       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
6742     }
6743 
6744     // Use indirect if the aggregate cannot fit into registers for
6745     // passing arguments according to the ABI
6746     unsigned Threshold = IsO32 ? 16 : 64;
6747 
6748     if(getContext().getTypeSizeInChars(Ty) > CharUnits::fromQuantity(Threshold))
6749       return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(Align), true,
6750                                      getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8 > Align);
6751 
6752     // If we have reached here, aggregates are passed directly by coercing to
6753     // another structure type. Padding is inserted if the offset of the
6754     // aggregate is unaligned.
6755     ABIArgInfo ArgInfo =
6756         ABIArgInfo::getDirect(HandleAggregates(Ty, TySize), 0,
6757                               getPaddingType(OrigOffset, CurrOffset));
6758     ArgInfo.setInReg(true);
6759     return ArgInfo;
6760   }
6761 
6762   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
6763   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
6764     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6765 
6766   // All integral types are promoted to the GPR width.
6767   if (Ty->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
6768     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend();
6769 
6770   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(
6771       nullptr, 0, IsO32 ? nullptr : getPaddingType(OrigOffset, CurrOffset));
6772 }
6773 
6774 llvm::Type*
6775 MipsABIInfo::returnAggregateInRegs(QualType RetTy, uint64_t Size) const {
6776   const RecordType *RT = RetTy->getAs<RecordType>();
6777   SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> RTList;
6778 
6779   if (RT && RT->isStructureOrClassType()) {
6780     const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl();
6781     const ASTRecordLayout &Layout = getContext().getASTRecordLayout(RD);
6782     unsigned FieldCnt = Layout.getFieldCount();
6783 
6784     // N32/64 returns struct/classes in floating point registers if the
6785     // following conditions are met:
6786     // 1. The size of the struct/class is no larger than 128-bit.
6787     // 2. The struct/class has one or two fields all of which are floating
6788     //    point types.
6789     // 3. The offset of the first field is zero (this follows what gcc does).
6790     //
6791     // Any other composite results are returned in integer registers.
6792     //
6793     if (FieldCnt && (FieldCnt <= 2) && !Layout.getFieldOffset(0)) {
6794       RecordDecl::field_iterator b = RD->field_begin(), e = RD->field_end();
6795       for (; b != e; ++b) {
6796         const BuiltinType *BT = b->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
6797 
6798         if (!BT || !BT->isFloatingPoint())
6799           break;
6800 
6801         RTList.push_back(CGT.ConvertType(b->getType()));
6802       }
6803 
6804       if (b == e)
6805         return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), RTList,
6806                                      RD->hasAttr<PackedAttr>());
6807 
6808       RTList.clear();
6809     }
6810   }
6811 
6812   CoerceToIntArgs(Size, RTList);
6813   return llvm::StructType::get(getVMContext(), RTList);
6814 }
6815 
6816 ABIArgInfo MipsABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
6817   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
6818 
6819   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
6820     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
6821 
6822   // O32 doesn't treat zero-sized structs differently from other structs.
6823   // However, N32/N64 ignores zero sized return values.
6824   if (!IsO32 && Size == 0)
6825     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
6826 
6827   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy) || RetTy->isVectorType()) {
6828     if (Size <= 128) {
6829       if (RetTy->isAnyComplexType())
6830         return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
6831 
6832       // O32 returns integer vectors in registers and N32/N64 returns all small
6833       // aggregates in registers.
6834       if (!IsO32 ||
6835           (RetTy->isVectorType() && !RetTy->hasFloatingRepresentation())) {
6836         ABIArgInfo ArgInfo =
6837             ABIArgInfo::getDirect(returnAggregateInRegs(RetTy, Size));
6838         ArgInfo.setInReg(true);
6839         return ArgInfo;
6840       }
6841     }
6842 
6843     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
6844   }
6845 
6846   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
6847   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
6848     RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
6849 
6850   return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
6851           ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
6852 }
6853 
6854 void MipsABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
6855   ABIArgInfo &RetInfo = FI.getReturnInfo();
6856   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
6857     RetInfo = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
6858 
6859   // Check if a pointer to an aggregate is passed as a hidden argument.
6860   uint64_t Offset = RetInfo.isIndirect() ? MinABIStackAlignInBytes : 0;
6861 
6862   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
6863     I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, Offset);
6864 }
6865 
6866 Address MipsABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
6867                                QualType OrigTy) const {
6868   QualType Ty = OrigTy;
6869 
6870   // Integer arguments are promoted to 32-bit on O32 and 64-bit on N32/N64.
6871   // Pointers are also promoted in the same way but this only matters for N32.
6872   unsigned SlotSizeInBits = IsO32 ? 32 : 64;
6873   unsigned PtrWidth = getTarget().getPointerWidth(0);
6874   bool DidPromote = false;
6875   if ((Ty->isIntegerType() &&
6876           getContext().getIntWidth(Ty) < SlotSizeInBits) ||
6877       (Ty->isPointerType() && PtrWidth < SlotSizeInBits)) {
6878     DidPromote = true;
6879     Ty = getContext().getIntTypeForBitwidth(SlotSizeInBits,
6880                                             Ty->isSignedIntegerType());
6881   }
6882 
6883   auto TyInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
6884 
6885   // The alignment of things in the argument area is never larger than
6886   // StackAlignInBytes.
6887   TyInfo.second =
6888     std::min(TyInfo.second, CharUnits::fromQuantity(StackAlignInBytes));
6889 
6890   // MinABIStackAlignInBytes is the size of argument slots on the stack.
6891   CharUnits ArgSlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(MinABIStackAlignInBytes);
6892 
6893   Address Addr = emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false,
6894                           TyInfo, ArgSlotSize, /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true);
6895 
6896 
6897   // If there was a promotion, "unpromote" into a temporary.
6898   // TODO: can we just use a pointer into a subset of the original slot?
6899   if (DidPromote) {
6900     Address Temp = CGF.CreateMemTemp(OrigTy, "vaarg.promotion-temp");
6901     llvm::Value *Promoted = CGF.Builder.CreateLoad(Addr);
6902 
6903     // Truncate down to the right width.
6904     llvm::Type *IntTy = (OrigTy->isIntegerType() ? Temp.getElementType()
6905                                                  : CGF.IntPtrTy);
6906     llvm::Value *V = CGF.Builder.CreateTrunc(Promoted, IntTy);
6907     if (OrigTy->isPointerType())
6908       V = CGF.Builder.CreateIntToPtr(V, Temp.getElementType());
6909 
6910     CGF.Builder.CreateStore(V, Temp);
6911     Addr = Temp;
6912   }
6913 
6914   return Addr;
6915 }
6916 
6917 bool MipsABIInfo::shouldSignExtUnsignedType(QualType Ty) const {
6918   int TySize = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
6919 
6920   // MIPS64 ABI requires unsigned 32 bit integers to be sign extended.
6921   if (Ty->isUnsignedIntegerOrEnumerationType() && TySize == 32)
6922     return true;
6923 
6924   return false;
6925 }
6926 
6927 bool
6928 MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
6929                                                llvm::Value *Address) const {
6930   // This information comes from gcc's implementation, which seems to
6931   // as canonical as it gets.
6932 
6933   // Everything on MIPS is 4 bytes.  Double-precision FP registers
6934   // are aliased to pairs of single-precision FP registers.
6935   llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(CGF.Int8Ty, 4);
6936 
6937   // 0-31 are the general purpose registers, $0 - $31.
6938   // 32-63 are the floating-point registers, $f0 - $f31.
6939   // 64 and 65 are the multiply/divide registers, $hi and $lo.
6940   // 66 is the (notional, I think) register for signal-handler return.
6941   AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 0, 65);
6942 
6943   // 67-74 are the floating-point status registers, $fcc0 - $fcc7.
6944   // They are one bit wide and ignored here.
6945 
6946   // 80-111 are the coprocessor 0 registers, $c0r0 - $c0r31.
6947   // (coprocessor 1 is the FP unit)
6948   // 112-143 are the coprocessor 2 registers, $c2r0 - $c2r31.
6949   // 144-175 are the coprocessor 3 registers, $c3r0 - $c3r31.
6950   // 176-181 are the DSP accumulator registers.
6951   AssignToArrayRange(CGF.Builder, Address, Four8, 80, 181);
6952   return false;
6953 }
6954 
6955 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6956 // AVR ABI Implementation.
6957 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6958 
6959 namespace {
6960 class AVRTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
6961 public:
6962   AVRTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
6963     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) { }
6964 
6965   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
6966                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const override {
6967     const auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
6968     if (!FD) return;
6969     auto *Fn = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
6970 
6971     if (FD->getAttr<AVRInterruptAttr>())
6972       Fn->addFnAttr("interrupt");
6973 
6974     if (FD->getAttr<AVRSignalAttr>())
6975       Fn->addFnAttr("signal");
6976   }
6977 };
6978 }
6979 
6980 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6981 // TCE ABI Implementation (see http://tce.cs.tut.fi). Uses mostly the defaults.
6982 // Currently subclassed only to implement custom OpenCL C function attribute
6983 // handling.
6984 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
6985 
6986 namespace {
6987 
6988 class TCETargetCodeGenInfo : public DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo {
6989 public:
6990   TCETargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
6991     : DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(CGT) {}
6992 
6993   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
6994                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override;
6995 };
6996 
6997 void TCETargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
6998     const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV, CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const {
6999   const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
7000   if (!FD) return;
7001 
7002   llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
7003 
7004   if (M.getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
7005     if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
7006       // OpenCL C Kernel functions are not subject to inlining
7007       F->addFnAttr(llvm::Attribute::NoInline);
7008       const ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr *Attr = FD->getAttr<ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr>();
7009       if (Attr) {
7010         // Convert the reqd_work_group_size() attributes to metadata.
7011         llvm::LLVMContext &Context = F->getContext();
7012         llvm::NamedMDNode *OpenCLMetadata =
7013             M.getModule().getOrInsertNamedMetadata(
7014                 "opencl.kernel_wg_size_info");
7015 
7016         SmallVector<llvm::Metadata *, 5> Operands;
7017         Operands.push_back(llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(F));
7018 
7019         Operands.push_back(
7020             llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue(
7021                 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getXDim()))));
7022         Operands.push_back(
7023             llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue(
7024                 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getYDim()))));
7025         Operands.push_back(
7026             llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::Constant::getIntegerValue(
7027                 M.Int32Ty, llvm::APInt(32, Attr->getZDim()))));
7028 
7029         // Add a boolean constant operand for "required" (true) or "hint"
7030         // (false) for implementing the work_group_size_hint attr later.
7031         // Currently always true as the hint is not yet implemented.
7032         Operands.push_back(
7033             llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(llvm::ConstantInt::getTrue(Context)));
7034         OpenCLMetadata->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Context, Operands));
7035       }
7036     }
7037   }
7038 }
7039 
7040 }
7041 
7042 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7043 // Hexagon ABI Implementation
7044 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7045 
7046 namespace {
7047 
7048 class HexagonABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
7049 
7050 
7051 public:
7052   HexagonABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {}
7053 
7054 private:
7055 
7056   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
7057   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy) const;
7058 
7059   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
7060 
7061   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7062                     QualType Ty) const override;
7063 };
7064 
7065 class HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
7066 public:
7067   HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
7068     :TargetCodeGenInfo(new HexagonABIInfo(CGT)) {}
7069 
7070   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
7071     return 29;
7072   }
7073 };
7074 
7075 }
7076 
7077 void HexagonABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
7078   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
7079     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
7080   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
7081     I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type);
7082 }
7083 
7084 ABIArgInfo HexagonABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
7085   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
7086     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
7087     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
7088       Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7089 
7090     return (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
7091             ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
7092   }
7093 
7094   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
7095     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
7096 
7097   // Ignore empty records.
7098   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
7099     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
7100 
7101   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
7102   if (Size > 64)
7103     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true);
7104     // Pass in the smallest viable integer type.
7105   else if (Size > 32)
7106       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()));
7107   else if (Size > 16)
7108       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()));
7109   else if (Size > 8)
7110       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()));
7111   else
7112       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()));
7113 }
7114 
7115 ABIArgInfo HexagonABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const {
7116   if (RetTy->isVoidType())
7117     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
7118 
7119   // Large vector types should be returned via memory.
7120   if (RetTy->isVectorType() && getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy) > 64)
7121     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy);
7122 
7123   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(RetTy)) {
7124     // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
7125     if (const EnumType *EnumTy = RetTy->getAs<EnumType>())
7126       RetTy = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7127 
7128     return (RetTy->isPromotableIntegerType() ?
7129             ABIArgInfo::getExtend() : ABIArgInfo::getDirect());
7130   }
7131 
7132   if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), RetTy, true))
7133     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
7134 
7135   // Aggregates <= 8 bytes are returned in r0; other aggregates
7136   // are returned indirectly.
7137   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(RetTy);
7138   if (Size <= 64) {
7139     // Return in the smallest viable integer type.
7140     if (Size <= 8)
7141       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt8Ty(getVMContext()));
7142     if (Size <= 16)
7143       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt16Ty(getVMContext()));
7144     if (Size <= 32)
7145       return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(getVMContext()));
7146     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(getVMContext()));
7147   }
7148 
7149   return getNaturalAlignIndirect(RetTy, /*ByVal=*/true);
7150 }
7151 
7152 Address HexagonABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7153                                   QualType Ty) const {
7154   // FIXME: Someone needs to audit that this handle alignment correctly.
7155   return emitVoidPtrVAArg(CGF, VAListAddr, Ty, /*indirect*/ false,
7156                           getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty),
7157                           CharUnits::fromQuantity(4),
7158                           /*AllowHigherAlign*/ true);
7159 }
7160 
7161 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7162 // Lanai ABI Implementation
7163 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7164 
7165 namespace {
7166 class LanaiABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
7167 public:
7168   LanaiABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
7169 
7170   bool shouldUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const;
7171 
7172   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override {
7173     CCState State(FI.getCallingConvention());
7174     // Lanai uses 4 registers to pass arguments unless the function has the
7175     // regparm attribute set.
7176     if (FI.getHasRegParm()) {
7177       State.FreeRegs = FI.getRegParm();
7178     } else {
7179       State.FreeRegs = 4;
7180     }
7181 
7182     if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
7183       FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
7184     for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
7185       I.info = classifyArgumentType(I.type, State);
7186   }
7187 
7188   ABIArgInfo getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal, CCState &State) const;
7189   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType RetTy, CCState &State) const;
7190 };
7191 } // end anonymous namespace
7192 
7193 bool LanaiABIInfo::shouldUseInReg(QualType Ty, CCState &State) const {
7194   unsigned Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
7195   unsigned SizeInRegs = llvm::alignTo(Size, 32U) / 32U;
7196 
7197   if (SizeInRegs == 0)
7198     return false;
7199 
7200   if (SizeInRegs > State.FreeRegs) {
7201     State.FreeRegs = 0;
7202     return false;
7203   }
7204 
7205   State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs;
7206 
7207   return true;
7208 }
7209 
7210 ABIArgInfo LanaiABIInfo::getIndirectResult(QualType Ty, bool ByVal,
7211                                            CCState &State) const {
7212   if (!ByVal) {
7213     if (State.FreeRegs) {
7214       --State.FreeRegs; // Non-byval indirects just use one pointer.
7215       return getNaturalAlignIndirectInReg(Ty);
7216     }
7217     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, false);
7218   }
7219 
7220   // Compute the byval alignment.
7221   const unsigned MinABIStackAlignInBytes = 4;
7222   unsigned TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlign(Ty) / 8;
7223   return ABIArgInfo::getIndirect(CharUnits::fromQuantity(4), /*ByVal=*/true,
7224                                  /*Realign=*/TypeAlign >
7225                                      MinABIStackAlignInBytes);
7226 }
7227 
7228 ABIArgInfo LanaiABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty,
7229                                               CCState &State) const {
7230   // Check with the C++ ABI first.
7231   const RecordType *RT = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
7232   if (RT) {
7233     CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(RT, getCXXABI());
7234     if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_Indirect) {
7235       return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false, State);
7236     } else if (RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory) {
7237       return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByRef=*/true);
7238     }
7239   }
7240 
7241   if (isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty)) {
7242     // Structures with flexible arrays are always indirect.
7243     if (RT && RT->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember())
7244       return getIndirectResult(Ty, /*ByVal=*/true, State);
7245 
7246     // Ignore empty structs/unions.
7247     if (isEmptyRecord(getContext(), Ty, true))
7248       return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
7249 
7250     llvm::LLVMContext &LLVMContext = getVMContext();
7251     unsigned SizeInRegs = (getContext().getTypeSize(Ty) + 31) / 32;
7252     if (SizeInRegs <= State.FreeRegs) {
7253       llvm::IntegerType *Int32 = llvm::Type::getInt32Ty(LLVMContext);
7254       SmallVector<llvm::Type *, 3> Elements(SizeInRegs, Int32);
7255       llvm::Type *Result = llvm::StructType::get(LLVMContext, Elements);
7256       State.FreeRegs -= SizeInRegs;
7257       return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(Result);
7258     } else {
7259       State.FreeRegs = 0;
7260     }
7261     return getIndirectResult(Ty, true, State);
7262   }
7263 
7264   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
7265   if (const auto *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
7266     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7267 
7268   bool InReg = shouldUseInReg(Ty, State);
7269   if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
7270     if (InReg)
7271       return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
7272     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend();
7273   }
7274   if (InReg)
7275     return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg();
7276   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
7277 }
7278 
7279 namespace {
7280 class LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
7281 public:
7282   LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
7283       : TargetCodeGenInfo(new LanaiABIInfo(CGT)) {}
7284 };
7285 }
7286 
7287 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7288 // AMDGPU ABI Implementation
7289 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7290 
7291 namespace {
7292 
7293 class AMDGPUABIInfo final : public DefaultABIInfo {
7294 public:
7295   explicit AMDGPUABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
7296 
7297 private:
7298   ABIArgInfo classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const;
7299 
7300   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
7301 };
7302 
7303 void AMDGPUABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
7304   if (!getCXXABI().classifyReturnType(FI))
7305     FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
7306 
7307   unsigned CC = FI.getCallingConvention();
7308   for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments())
7309     if (CC == llvm::CallingConv::AMDGPU_KERNEL)
7310       Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type);
7311     else
7312       Arg.info = DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Arg.type);
7313 }
7314 
7315 /// \brief Classify argument of given type \p Ty.
7316 ABIArgInfo AMDGPUABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(QualType Ty) const {
7317   llvm::StructType *StrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(CGT.ConvertType(Ty));
7318   if (!StrTy) {
7319     return DefaultABIInfo::classifyArgumentType(Ty);
7320   }
7321 
7322   // Coerce single element structs to its element.
7323   if (StrTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
7324     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
7325   }
7326 
7327   // If we set CanBeFlattened to true, CodeGen will expand the struct to its
7328   // individual elements, which confuses the Clover OpenCL backend; therefore we
7329   // have to set it to false here. Other args of getDirect() are just defaults.
7330   return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(nullptr, 0, nullptr, false);
7331 }
7332 
7333 class AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
7334 public:
7335   AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
7336     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new AMDGPUABIInfo(CGT)) {}
7337   void setTargetAttributes(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
7338                            CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override;
7339   unsigned getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const override;
7340 
7341   llvm::Constant *getNullPointer(const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
7342       llvm::PointerType *T, QualType QT) const override;
7343 
7344   unsigned getASTAllocaAddressSpace() const override {
7345     return LangAS::FirstTargetAddressSpace +
7346            getABIInfo().getDataLayout().getAllocaAddrSpace();
7347   }
7348   unsigned getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM,
7349                                     const VarDecl *D) const override;
7350 };
7351 }
7352 
7353 void AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::setTargetAttributes(
7354     const Decl *D,
7355     llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
7356     CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const {
7357   const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(D);
7358   if (!FD)
7359     return;
7360 
7361   llvm::Function *F = cast<llvm::Function>(GV);
7362 
7363   const auto *ReqdWGS = M.getLangOpts().OpenCL ?
7364     FD->getAttr<ReqdWorkGroupSizeAttr>() : nullptr;
7365   const auto *FlatWGS = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUFlatWorkGroupSizeAttr>();
7366   if (ReqdWGS || FlatWGS) {
7367     unsigned Min = FlatWGS ? FlatWGS->getMin() : 0;
7368     unsigned Max = FlatWGS ? FlatWGS->getMax() : 0;
7369     if (ReqdWGS && Min == 0 && Max == 0)
7370       Min = Max = ReqdWGS->getXDim() * ReqdWGS->getYDim() * ReqdWGS->getZDim();
7371 
7372     if (Min != 0) {
7373       assert(Min <= Max && "Min must be less than or equal Max");
7374 
7375       std::string AttrVal = llvm::utostr(Min) + "," + llvm::utostr(Max);
7376       F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-flat-work-group-size", AttrVal);
7377     } else
7378       assert(Max == 0 && "Max must be zero");
7379   }
7380 
7381   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUWavesPerEUAttr>()) {
7382     unsigned Min = Attr->getMin();
7383     unsigned Max = Attr->getMax();
7384 
7385     if (Min != 0) {
7386       assert((Max == 0 || Min <= Max) && "Min must be less than or equal Max");
7387 
7388       std::string AttrVal = llvm::utostr(Min);
7389       if (Max != 0)
7390         AttrVal = AttrVal + "," + llvm::utostr(Max);
7391       F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-waves-per-eu", AttrVal);
7392     } else
7393       assert(Max == 0 && "Max must be zero");
7394   }
7395 
7396   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUNumSGPRAttr>()) {
7397     unsigned NumSGPR = Attr->getNumSGPR();
7398 
7399     if (NumSGPR != 0)
7400       F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-num-sgpr", llvm::utostr(NumSGPR));
7401   }
7402 
7403   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AMDGPUNumVGPRAttr>()) {
7404     uint32_t NumVGPR = Attr->getNumVGPR();
7405 
7406     if (NumVGPR != 0)
7407       F->addFnAttr("amdgpu-num-vgpr", llvm::utostr(NumVGPR));
7408   }
7409 }
7410 
7411 unsigned AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const {
7412   return llvm::CallingConv::AMDGPU_KERNEL;
7413 }
7414 
7415 // Currently LLVM assumes null pointers always have value 0,
7416 // which results in incorrectly transformed IR. Therefore, instead of
7417 // emitting null pointers in private and local address spaces, a null
7418 // pointer in generic address space is emitted which is casted to a
7419 // pointer in local or private address space.
7420 llvm::Constant *AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getNullPointer(
7421     const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, llvm::PointerType *PT,
7422     QualType QT) const {
7423   if (CGM.getContext().getTargetNullPointerValue(QT) == 0)
7424     return llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(PT);
7425 
7426   auto &Ctx = CGM.getContext();
7427   auto NPT = llvm::PointerType::get(PT->getElementType(),
7428       Ctx.getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_generic));
7429   return llvm::ConstantExpr::getAddrSpaceCast(
7430       llvm::ConstantPointerNull::get(NPT), PT);
7431 }
7432 
7433 unsigned
7434 AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo::getGlobalVarAddressSpace(CodeGenModule &CGM,
7435                                                   const VarDecl *D) const {
7436   assert(!CGM.getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
7437          !(CGM.getLangOpts().CUDA && CGM.getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) &&
7438          "Address space agnostic languages only");
7439   unsigned DefaultGlobalAS =
7440       LangAS::FirstTargetAddressSpace +
7441       CGM.getContext().getTargetAddressSpace(LangAS::opencl_global);
7442   if (!D)
7443     return DefaultGlobalAS;
7444 
7445   unsigned AddrSpace = D->getType().getAddressSpace();
7446   assert(AddrSpace == LangAS::Default ||
7447          AddrSpace >= LangAS::FirstTargetAddressSpace);
7448   if (AddrSpace != LangAS::Default)
7449     return AddrSpace;
7450 
7451   if (CGM.isTypeConstant(D->getType(), false)) {
7452     if (auto ConstAS = CGM.getTarget().getConstantAddressSpace())
7453       return ConstAS.getValue();
7454   }
7455   return DefaultGlobalAS;
7456 }
7457 
7458 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7459 // SPARC v8 ABI Implementation.
7460 // Based on the SPARC Compliance Definition version 2.4.1.
7461 //
7462 // Ensures that complex values are passed in registers.
7463 //
7464 namespace {
7465 class SparcV8ABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
7466 public:
7467   SparcV8ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
7468 
7469 private:
7470   ABIArgInfo classifyReturnType(QualType RetTy) const;
7471   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
7472 };
7473 } // end anonymous namespace
7474 
7475 
7476 ABIArgInfo
7477 SparcV8ABIInfo::classifyReturnType(QualType Ty) const {
7478   if (Ty->isAnyComplexType()) {
7479     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
7480   }
7481   else {
7482     return DefaultABIInfo::classifyReturnType(Ty);
7483   }
7484 }
7485 
7486 void SparcV8ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
7487 
7488   FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyReturnType(FI.getReturnType());
7489   for (auto &Arg : FI.arguments())
7490     Arg.info = classifyArgumentType(Arg.type);
7491 }
7492 
7493 namespace {
7494 class SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
7495 public:
7496   SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
7497     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SparcV8ABIInfo(CGT)) {}
7498 };
7499 } // end anonymous namespace
7500 
7501 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7502 // SPARC v9 ABI Implementation.
7503 // Based on the SPARC Compliance Definition version 2.4.1.
7504 //
7505 // Function arguments a mapped to a nominal "parameter array" and promoted to
7506 // registers depending on their type. Each argument occupies 8 or 16 bytes in
7507 // the array, structs larger than 16 bytes are passed indirectly.
7508 //
7509 // One case requires special care:
7510 //
7511 //   struct mixed {
7512 //     int i;
7513 //     float f;
7514 //   };
7515 //
7516 // When a struct mixed is passed by value, it only occupies 8 bytes in the
7517 // parameter array, but the int is passed in an integer register, and the float
7518 // is passed in a floating point register. This is represented as two arguments
7519 // with the LLVM IR inreg attribute:
7520 //
7521 //   declare void f(i32 inreg %i, float inreg %f)
7522 //
7523 // The code generator will only allocate 4 bytes from the parameter array for
7524 // the inreg arguments. All other arguments are allocated a multiple of 8
7525 // bytes.
7526 //
7527 namespace {
7528 class SparcV9ABIInfo : public ABIInfo {
7529 public:
7530   SparcV9ABIInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT) : ABIInfo(CGT) {}
7531 
7532 private:
7533   ABIArgInfo classifyType(QualType RetTy, unsigned SizeLimit) const;
7534   void computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const override;
7535   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7536                     QualType Ty) const override;
7537 
7538   // Coercion type builder for structs passed in registers. The coercion type
7539   // serves two purposes:
7540   //
7541   // 1. Pad structs to a multiple of 64 bits, so they are passed 'left-aligned'
7542   //    in registers.
7543   // 2. Expose aligned floating point elements as first-level elements, so the
7544   //    code generator knows to pass them in floating point registers.
7545   //
7546   // We also compute the InReg flag which indicates that the struct contains
7547   // aligned 32-bit floats.
7548   //
7549   struct CoerceBuilder {
7550     llvm::LLVMContext &Context;
7551     const llvm::DataLayout &DL;
7552     SmallVector<llvm::Type*, 8> Elems;
7553     uint64_t Size;
7554     bool InReg;
7555 
7556     CoerceBuilder(llvm::LLVMContext &c, const llvm::DataLayout &dl)
7557       : Context(c), DL(dl), Size(0), InReg(false) {}
7558 
7559     // Pad Elems with integers until Size is ToSize.
7560     void pad(uint64_t ToSize) {
7561       assert(ToSize >= Size && "Cannot remove elements");
7562       if (ToSize == Size)
7563         return;
7564 
7565       // Finish the current 64-bit word.
7566       uint64_t Aligned = llvm::alignTo(Size, 64);
7567       if (Aligned > Size && Aligned <= ToSize) {
7568         Elems.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(Context, Aligned - Size));
7569         Size = Aligned;
7570       }
7571 
7572       // Add whole 64-bit words.
7573       while (Size + 64 <= ToSize) {
7574         Elems.push_back(llvm::Type::getInt64Ty(Context));
7575         Size += 64;
7576       }
7577 
7578       // Final in-word padding.
7579       if (Size < ToSize) {
7580         Elems.push_back(llvm::IntegerType::get(Context, ToSize - Size));
7581         Size = ToSize;
7582       }
7583     }
7584 
7585     // Add a floating point element at Offset.
7586     void addFloat(uint64_t Offset, llvm::Type *Ty, unsigned Bits) {
7587       // Unaligned floats are treated as integers.
7588       if (Offset % Bits)
7589         return;
7590       // The InReg flag is only required if there are any floats < 64 bits.
7591       if (Bits < 64)
7592         InReg = true;
7593       pad(Offset);
7594       Elems.push_back(Ty);
7595       Size = Offset + Bits;
7596     }
7597 
7598     // Add a struct type to the coercion type, starting at Offset (in bits).
7599     void addStruct(uint64_t Offset, llvm::StructType *StrTy) {
7600       const llvm::StructLayout *Layout = DL.getStructLayout(StrTy);
7601       for (unsigned i = 0, e = StrTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
7602         llvm::Type *ElemTy = StrTy->getElementType(i);
7603         uint64_t ElemOffset = Offset + Layout->getElementOffsetInBits(i);
7604         switch (ElemTy->getTypeID()) {
7605         case llvm::Type::StructTyID:
7606           addStruct(ElemOffset, cast<llvm::StructType>(ElemTy));
7607           break;
7608         case llvm::Type::FloatTyID:
7609           addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 32);
7610           break;
7611         case llvm::Type::DoubleTyID:
7612           addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 64);
7613           break;
7614         case llvm::Type::FP128TyID:
7615           addFloat(ElemOffset, ElemTy, 128);
7616           break;
7617         case llvm::Type::PointerTyID:
7618           if (ElemOffset % 64 == 0) {
7619             pad(ElemOffset);
7620             Elems.push_back(ElemTy);
7621             Size += 64;
7622           }
7623           break;
7624         default:
7625           break;
7626         }
7627       }
7628     }
7629 
7630     // Check if Ty is a usable substitute for the coercion type.
7631     bool isUsableType(llvm::StructType *Ty) const {
7632       return llvm::makeArrayRef(Elems) == Ty->elements();
7633     }
7634 
7635     // Get the coercion type as a literal struct type.
7636     llvm::Type *getType() const {
7637       if (Elems.size() == 1)
7638         return Elems.front();
7639       else
7640         return llvm::StructType::get(Context, Elems);
7641     }
7642   };
7643 };
7644 } // end anonymous namespace
7645 
7646 ABIArgInfo
7647 SparcV9ABIInfo::classifyType(QualType Ty, unsigned SizeLimit) const {
7648   if (Ty->isVoidType())
7649     return ABIArgInfo::getIgnore();
7650 
7651   uint64_t Size = getContext().getTypeSize(Ty);
7652 
7653   // Anything too big to fit in registers is passed with an explicit indirect
7654   // pointer / sret pointer.
7655   if (Size > SizeLimit)
7656     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, /*ByVal=*/false);
7657 
7658   // Treat an enum type as its underlying type.
7659   if (const EnumType *EnumTy = Ty->getAs<EnumType>())
7660     Ty = EnumTy->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
7661 
7662   // Integer types smaller than a register are extended.
7663   if (Size < 64 && Ty->isIntegerType())
7664     return ABIArgInfo::getExtend();
7665 
7666   // Other non-aggregates go in registers.
7667   if (!isAggregateTypeForABI(Ty))
7668     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
7669 
7670   // If a C++ object has either a non-trivial copy constructor or a non-trivial
7671   // destructor, it is passed with an explicit indirect pointer / sret pointer.
7672   if (CGCXXABI::RecordArgABI RAA = getRecordArgABI(Ty, getCXXABI()))
7673     return getNaturalAlignIndirect(Ty, RAA == CGCXXABI::RAA_DirectInMemory);
7674 
7675   // This is a small aggregate type that should be passed in registers.
7676   // Build a coercion type from the LLVM struct type.
7677   llvm::StructType *StrTy = dyn_cast<llvm::StructType>(CGT.ConvertType(Ty));
7678   if (!StrTy)
7679     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect();
7680 
7681   CoerceBuilder CB(getVMContext(), getDataLayout());
7682   CB.addStruct(0, StrTy);
7683   CB.pad(llvm::alignTo(CB.DL.getTypeSizeInBits(StrTy), 64));
7684 
7685   // Try to use the original type for coercion.
7686   llvm::Type *CoerceTy = CB.isUsableType(StrTy) ? StrTy : CB.getType();
7687 
7688   if (CB.InReg)
7689     return ABIArgInfo::getDirectInReg(CoerceTy);
7690   else
7691     return ABIArgInfo::getDirect(CoerceTy);
7692 }
7693 
7694 Address SparcV9ABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7695                                   QualType Ty) const {
7696   ABIArgInfo AI = classifyType(Ty, 16 * 8);
7697   llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
7698   if (AI.canHaveCoerceToType() && !AI.getCoerceToType())
7699     AI.setCoerceToType(ArgTy);
7700 
7701   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(8);
7702 
7703   CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
7704   Address Addr(Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr, "ap.cur"), SlotSize);
7705   llvm::Type *ArgPtrTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(ArgTy);
7706 
7707   auto TypeInfo = getContext().getTypeInfoInChars(Ty);
7708 
7709   Address ArgAddr = Address::invalid();
7710   CharUnits Stride;
7711   switch (AI.getKind()) {
7712   case ABIArgInfo::Expand:
7713   case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand:
7714   case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca:
7715     llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI kind for va_arg");
7716 
7717   case ABIArgInfo::Extend: {
7718     Stride = SlotSize;
7719     CharUnits Offset = SlotSize - TypeInfo.first;
7720     ArgAddr = Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr, Offset, "extend");
7721     break;
7722   }
7723 
7724   case ABIArgInfo::Direct: {
7725     auto AllocSize = getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AI.getCoerceToType());
7726     Stride = CharUnits::fromQuantity(AllocSize).alignTo(SlotSize);
7727     ArgAddr = Addr;
7728     break;
7729   }
7730 
7731   case ABIArgInfo::Indirect:
7732     Stride = SlotSize;
7733     ArgAddr = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(Addr, ArgPtrTy, "indirect");
7734     ArgAddr = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(ArgAddr, "indirect.arg"),
7735                       TypeInfo.second);
7736     break;
7737 
7738   case ABIArgInfo::Ignore:
7739     return Address(llvm::UndefValue::get(ArgPtrTy), TypeInfo.second);
7740   }
7741 
7742   // Update VAList.
7743   llvm::Value *NextPtr =
7744     Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(Addr.getPointer(), Stride, "ap.next");
7745   Builder.CreateStore(NextPtr, VAListAddr);
7746 
7747   return Builder.CreateBitCast(ArgAddr, ArgPtrTy, "arg.addr");
7748 }
7749 
7750 void SparcV9ABIInfo::computeInfo(CGFunctionInfo &FI) const {
7751   FI.getReturnInfo() = classifyType(FI.getReturnType(), 32 * 8);
7752   for (auto &I : FI.arguments())
7753     I.info = classifyType(I.type, 16 * 8);
7754 }
7755 
7756 namespace {
7757 class SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
7758 public:
7759   SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
7760     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new SparcV9ABIInfo(CGT)) {}
7761 
7762   int getDwarfEHStackPointer(CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override {
7763     return 14;
7764   }
7765 
7766   bool initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
7767                                llvm::Value *Address) const override;
7768 };
7769 } // end anonymous namespace
7770 
7771 bool
7772 SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo::initDwarfEHRegSizeTable(CodeGen::CodeGenFunction &CGF,
7773                                                 llvm::Value *Address) const {
7774   // This is calculated from the LLVM and GCC tables and verified
7775   // against gcc output.  AFAIK all ABIs use the same encoding.
7776 
7777   CodeGen::CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
7778 
7779   llvm::IntegerType *i8 = CGF.Int8Ty;
7780   llvm::Value *Four8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 4);
7781   llvm::Value *Eight8 = llvm::ConstantInt::get(i8, 8);
7782 
7783   // 0-31: the 8-byte general-purpose registers
7784   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 0, 31);
7785 
7786   // 32-63: f0-31, the 4-byte floating-point registers
7787   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Four8, 32, 63);
7788 
7789   //   Y   = 64
7790   //   PSR = 65
7791   //   WIM = 66
7792   //   TBR = 67
7793   //   PC  = 68
7794   //   NPC = 69
7795   //   FSR = 70
7796   //   CSR = 71
7797   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 64, 71);
7798 
7799   // 72-87: d0-15, the 8-byte floating-point registers
7800   AssignToArrayRange(Builder, Address, Eight8, 72, 87);
7801 
7802   return false;
7803 }
7804 
7805 
7806 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7807 // XCore ABI Implementation
7808 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7809 
7810 namespace {
7811 
7812 /// A SmallStringEnc instance is used to build up the TypeString by passing
7813 /// it by reference between functions that append to it.
7814 typedef llvm::SmallString<128> SmallStringEnc;
7815 
7816 /// TypeStringCache caches the meta encodings of Types.
7817 ///
7818 /// The reason for caching TypeStrings is two fold:
7819 ///   1. To cache a type's encoding for later uses;
7820 ///   2. As a means to break recursive member type inclusion.
7821 ///
7822 /// A cache Entry can have a Status of:
7823 ///   NonRecursive:   The type encoding is not recursive;
7824 ///   Recursive:      The type encoding is recursive;
7825 ///   Incomplete:     An incomplete TypeString;
7826 ///   IncompleteUsed: An incomplete TypeString that has been used in a
7827 ///                   Recursive type encoding.
7828 ///
7829 /// A NonRecursive entry will have all of its sub-members expanded as fully
7830 /// as possible. Whilst it may contain types which are recursive, the type
7831 /// itself is not recursive and thus its encoding may be safely used whenever
7832 /// the type is encountered.
7833 ///
7834 /// A Recursive entry will have all of its sub-members expanded as fully as
7835 /// possible. The type itself is recursive and it may contain other types which
7836 /// are recursive. The Recursive encoding must not be used during the expansion
7837 /// of a recursive type's recursive branch. For simplicity the code uses
7838 /// IncompleteCount to reject all usage of Recursive encodings for member types.
7839 ///
7840 /// An Incomplete entry is always a RecordType and only encodes its
7841 /// identifier e.g. "s(S){}". Incomplete 'StubEnc' entries are ephemeral and
7842 /// are placed into the cache during type expansion as a means to identify and
7843 /// handle recursive inclusion of types as sub-members. If there is recursion
7844 /// the entry becomes IncompleteUsed.
7845 ///
7846 /// During the expansion of a RecordType's members:
7847 ///
7848 ///   If the cache contains a NonRecursive encoding for the member type, the
7849 ///   cached encoding is used;
7850 ///
7851 ///   If the cache contains a Recursive encoding for the member type, the
7852 ///   cached encoding is 'Swapped' out, as it may be incorrect, and...
7853 ///
7854 ///   If the member is a RecordType, an Incomplete encoding is placed into the
7855 ///   cache to break potential recursive inclusion of itself as a sub-member;
7856 ///
7857 ///   Once a member RecordType has been expanded, its temporary incomplete
7858 ///   entry is removed from the cache. If a Recursive encoding was swapped out
7859 ///   it is swapped back in;
7860 ///
7861 ///   If an incomplete entry is used to expand a sub-member, the incomplete
7862 ///   entry is marked as IncompleteUsed. The cache keeps count of how many
7863 ///   IncompleteUsed entries it currently contains in IncompleteUsedCount;
7864 ///
7865 ///   If a member's encoding is found to be a NonRecursive or Recursive viz:
7866 ///   IncompleteUsedCount==0, the member's encoding is added to the cache.
7867 ///   Else the member is part of a recursive type and thus the recursion has
7868 ///   been exited too soon for the encoding to be correct for the member.
7869 ///
7870 class TypeStringCache {
7871   enum Status {NonRecursive, Recursive, Incomplete, IncompleteUsed};
7872   struct Entry {
7873     std::string Str;     // The encoded TypeString for the type.
7874     enum Status State;   // Information about the encoding in 'Str'.
7875     std::string Swapped; // A temporary place holder for a Recursive encoding
7876                          // during the expansion of RecordType's members.
7877   };
7878   std::map<const IdentifierInfo *, struct Entry> Map;
7879   unsigned IncompleteCount;     // Number of Incomplete entries in the Map.
7880   unsigned IncompleteUsedCount; // Number of IncompleteUsed entries in the Map.
7881 public:
7882   TypeStringCache() : IncompleteCount(0), IncompleteUsedCount(0) {}
7883   void addIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, std::string StubEnc);
7884   bool removeIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID);
7885   void addIfComplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, StringRef Str,
7886                      bool IsRecursive);
7887   StringRef lookupStr(const IdentifierInfo *ID);
7888 };
7889 
7890 /// TypeString encodings for enum & union fields must be order.
7891 /// FieldEncoding is a helper for this ordering process.
7892 class FieldEncoding {
7893   bool HasName;
7894   std::string Enc;
7895 public:
7896   FieldEncoding(bool b, SmallStringEnc &e) : HasName(b), Enc(e.c_str()) {}
7897   StringRef str() { return Enc; }
7898   bool operator<(const FieldEncoding &rhs) const {
7899     if (HasName != rhs.HasName) return HasName;
7900     return Enc < rhs.Enc;
7901   }
7902 };
7903 
7904 class XCoreABIInfo : public DefaultABIInfo {
7905 public:
7906   XCoreABIInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT) : DefaultABIInfo(CGT) {}
7907   Address EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7908                     QualType Ty) const override;
7909 };
7910 
7911 class XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
7912   mutable TypeStringCache TSC;
7913 public:
7914   XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGenTypes &CGT)
7915     :TargetCodeGenInfo(new XCoreABIInfo(CGT)) {}
7916   void emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
7917                     CodeGen::CodeGenModule &M) const override;
7918 };
7919 
7920 } // End anonymous namespace.
7921 
7922 // TODO: this implementation is likely now redundant with the default
7923 // EmitVAArg.
7924 Address XCoreABIInfo::EmitVAArg(CodeGenFunction &CGF, Address VAListAddr,
7925                                 QualType Ty) const {
7926   CGBuilderTy &Builder = CGF.Builder;
7927 
7928   // Get the VAList.
7929   CharUnits SlotSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(4);
7930   Address AP(Builder.CreateLoad(VAListAddr), SlotSize);
7931 
7932   // Handle the argument.
7933   ABIArgInfo AI = classifyArgumentType(Ty);
7934   CharUnits TypeAlign = getContext().getTypeAlignInChars(Ty);
7935   llvm::Type *ArgTy = CGT.ConvertType(Ty);
7936   if (AI.canHaveCoerceToType() && !AI.getCoerceToType())
7937     AI.setCoerceToType(ArgTy);
7938   llvm::Type *ArgPtrTy = llvm::PointerType::getUnqual(ArgTy);
7939 
7940   Address Val = Address::invalid();
7941   CharUnits ArgSize = CharUnits::Zero();
7942   switch (AI.getKind()) {
7943   case ABIArgInfo::Expand:
7944   case ABIArgInfo::CoerceAndExpand:
7945   case ABIArgInfo::InAlloca:
7946     llvm_unreachable("Unsupported ABI kind for va_arg");
7947   case ABIArgInfo::Ignore:
7948     Val = Address(llvm::UndefValue::get(ArgPtrTy), TypeAlign);
7949     ArgSize = CharUnits::Zero();
7950     break;
7951   case ABIArgInfo::Extend:
7952   case ABIArgInfo::Direct:
7953     Val = Builder.CreateBitCast(AP, ArgPtrTy);
7954     ArgSize = CharUnits::fromQuantity(
7955                        getDataLayout().getTypeAllocSize(AI.getCoerceToType()));
7956     ArgSize = ArgSize.alignTo(SlotSize);
7957     break;
7958   case ABIArgInfo::Indirect:
7959     Val = Builder.CreateElementBitCast(AP, ArgPtrTy);
7960     Val = Address(Builder.CreateLoad(Val), TypeAlign);
7961     ArgSize = SlotSize;
7962     break;
7963   }
7964 
7965   // Increment the VAList.
7966   if (!ArgSize.isZero()) {
7967     llvm::Value *APN =
7968       Builder.CreateConstInBoundsByteGEP(AP.getPointer(), ArgSize);
7969     Builder.CreateStore(APN, VAListAddr);
7970   }
7971 
7972   return Val;
7973 }
7974 
7975 /// During the expansion of a RecordType, an incomplete TypeString is placed
7976 /// into the cache as a means to identify and break recursion.
7977 /// If there is a Recursive encoding in the cache, it is swapped out and will
7978 /// be reinserted by removeIncomplete().
7979 /// All other types of encoding should have been used rather than arriving here.
7980 void TypeStringCache::addIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID,
7981                                     std::string StubEnc) {
7982   if (!ID)
7983     return;
7984   Entry &E = Map[ID];
7985   assert( (E.Str.empty() || E.State == Recursive) &&
7986          "Incorrectly use of addIncomplete");
7987   assert(!StubEnc.empty() && "Passing an empty string to addIncomplete()");
7988   E.Swapped.swap(E.Str); // swap out the Recursive
7989   E.Str.swap(StubEnc);
7990   E.State = Incomplete;
7991   ++IncompleteCount;
7992 }
7993 
7994 /// Once the RecordType has been expanded, the temporary incomplete TypeString
7995 /// must be removed from the cache.
7996 /// If a Recursive was swapped out by addIncomplete(), it will be replaced.
7997 /// Returns true if the RecordType was defined recursively.
7998 bool TypeStringCache::removeIncomplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID) {
7999   if (!ID)
8000     return false;
8001   auto I = Map.find(ID);
8002   assert(I != Map.end() && "Entry not present");
8003   Entry &E = I->second;
8004   assert( (E.State == Incomplete ||
8005            E.State == IncompleteUsed) &&
8006          "Entry must be an incomplete type");
8007   bool IsRecursive = false;
8008   if (E.State == IncompleteUsed) {
8009     // We made use of our Incomplete encoding, thus we are recursive.
8010     IsRecursive = true;
8011     --IncompleteUsedCount;
8012   }
8013   if (E.Swapped.empty())
8014     Map.erase(I);
8015   else {
8016     // Swap the Recursive back.
8017     E.Swapped.swap(E.Str);
8018     E.Swapped.clear();
8019     E.State = Recursive;
8020   }
8021   --IncompleteCount;
8022   return IsRecursive;
8023 }
8024 
8025 /// Add the encoded TypeString to the cache only if it is NonRecursive or
8026 /// Recursive (viz: all sub-members were expanded as fully as possible).
8027 void TypeStringCache::addIfComplete(const IdentifierInfo *ID, StringRef Str,
8028                                     bool IsRecursive) {
8029   if (!ID || IncompleteUsedCount)
8030     return; // No key or it is is an incomplete sub-type so don't add.
8031   Entry &E = Map[ID];
8032   if (IsRecursive && !E.Str.empty()) {
8033     assert(E.State==Recursive && E.Str.size() == Str.size() &&
8034            "This is not the same Recursive entry");
8035     // The parent container was not recursive after all, so we could have used
8036     // this Recursive sub-member entry after all, but we assumed the worse when
8037     // we started viz: IncompleteCount!=0.
8038     return;
8039   }
8040   assert(E.Str.empty() && "Entry already present");
8041   E.Str = Str.str();
8042   E.State = IsRecursive? Recursive : NonRecursive;
8043 }
8044 
8045 /// Return a cached TypeString encoding for the ID. If there isn't one, or we
8046 /// are recursively expanding a type (IncompleteCount != 0) and the cached
8047 /// encoding is Recursive, return an empty StringRef.
8048 StringRef TypeStringCache::lookupStr(const IdentifierInfo *ID) {
8049   if (!ID)
8050     return StringRef();   // We have no key.
8051   auto I = Map.find(ID);
8052   if (I == Map.end())
8053     return StringRef();   // We have no encoding.
8054   Entry &E = I->second;
8055   if (E.State == Recursive && IncompleteCount)
8056     return StringRef();   // We don't use Recursive encodings for member types.
8057 
8058   if (E.State == Incomplete) {
8059     // The incomplete type is being used to break out of recursion.
8060     E.State = IncompleteUsed;
8061     ++IncompleteUsedCount;
8062   }
8063   return E.Str;
8064 }
8065 
8066 /// The XCore ABI includes a type information section that communicates symbol
8067 /// type information to the linker. The linker uses this information to verify
8068 /// safety/correctness of things such as array bound and pointers et al.
8069 /// The ABI only requires C (and XC) language modules to emit TypeStrings.
8070 /// This type information (TypeString) is emitted into meta data for all global
8071 /// symbols: definitions, declarations, functions & variables.
8072 ///
8073 /// The TypeString carries type, qualifier, name, size & value details.
8074 /// Please see 'Tools Development Guide' section 2.16.2 for format details:
8075 /// https://www.xmos.com/download/public/Tools-Development-Guide%28X9114A%29.pdf
8076 /// The output is tested by test/CodeGen/xcore-stringtype.c.
8077 ///
8078 static bool getTypeString(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const Decl *D,
8079                           CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, TypeStringCache &TSC);
8080 
8081 /// XCore uses emitTargetMD to emit TypeString metadata for global symbols.
8082 void XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo::emitTargetMD(const Decl *D, llvm::GlobalValue *GV,
8083                                           CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM) const {
8084   SmallStringEnc Enc;
8085   if (getTypeString(Enc, D, CGM, TSC)) {
8086     llvm::LLVMContext &Ctx = CGM.getModule().getContext();
8087     llvm::Metadata *MDVals[] = {llvm::ConstantAsMetadata::get(GV),
8088                                 llvm::MDString::get(Ctx, Enc.str())};
8089     llvm::NamedMDNode *MD =
8090       CGM.getModule().getOrInsertNamedMetadata("xcore.typestrings");
8091     MD->addOperand(llvm::MDNode::get(Ctx, MDVals));
8092   }
8093 }
8094 
8095 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8096 // SPIR ABI Implementation
8097 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8098 
8099 namespace {
8100 class SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo : public TargetCodeGenInfo {
8101 public:
8102   SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo(CodeGen::CodeGenTypes &CGT)
8103     : TargetCodeGenInfo(new DefaultABIInfo(CGT)) {}
8104   unsigned getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const override;
8105 };
8106 
8107 } // End anonymous namespace.
8108 
8109 namespace clang {
8110 namespace CodeGen {
8111 void computeSPIRKernelABIInfo(CodeGenModule &CGM, CGFunctionInfo &FI) {
8112   DefaultABIInfo SPIRABI(CGM.getTypes());
8113   SPIRABI.computeInfo(FI);
8114 }
8115 }
8116 }
8117 
8118 unsigned SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo::getOpenCLKernelCallingConv() const {
8119   return llvm::CallingConv::SPIR_KERNEL;
8120 }
8121 
8122 static bool appendType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QType,
8123                        const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
8124                        TypeStringCache &TSC);
8125 
8126 /// Helper function for appendRecordType().
8127 /// Builds a SmallVector containing the encoded field types in declaration
8128 /// order.
8129 static bool extractFieldType(SmallVectorImpl<FieldEncoding> &FE,
8130                              const RecordDecl *RD,
8131                              const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
8132                              TypeStringCache &TSC) {
8133   for (const auto *Field : RD->fields()) {
8134     SmallStringEnc Enc;
8135     Enc += "m(";
8136     Enc += Field->getName();
8137     Enc += "){";
8138     if (Field->isBitField()) {
8139       Enc += "b(";
8140       llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Enc);
8141       OS << Field->getBitWidthValue(CGM.getContext());
8142       Enc += ':';
8143     }
8144     if (!appendType(Enc, Field->getType(), CGM, TSC))
8145       return false;
8146     if (Field->isBitField())
8147       Enc += ')';
8148     Enc += '}';
8149     FE.emplace_back(!Field->getName().empty(), Enc);
8150   }
8151   return true;
8152 }
8153 
8154 /// Appends structure and union types to Enc and adds encoding to cache.
8155 /// Recursively calls appendType (via extractFieldType) for each field.
8156 /// Union types have their fields ordered according to the ABI.
8157 static bool appendRecordType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const RecordType *RT,
8158                              const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
8159                              TypeStringCache &TSC, const IdentifierInfo *ID) {
8160   // Append the cached TypeString if we have one.
8161   StringRef TypeString = TSC.lookupStr(ID);
8162   if (!TypeString.empty()) {
8163     Enc += TypeString;
8164     return true;
8165   }
8166 
8167   // Start to emit an incomplete TypeString.
8168   size_t Start = Enc.size();
8169   Enc += (RT->isUnionType()? 'u' : 's');
8170   Enc += '(';
8171   if (ID)
8172     Enc += ID->getName();
8173   Enc += "){";
8174 
8175   // We collect all encoded fields and order as necessary.
8176   bool IsRecursive = false;
8177   const RecordDecl *RD = RT->getDecl()->getDefinition();
8178   if (RD && !RD->field_empty()) {
8179     // An incomplete TypeString stub is placed in the cache for this RecordType
8180     // so that recursive calls to this RecordType will use it whilst building a
8181     // complete TypeString for this RecordType.
8182     SmallVector<FieldEncoding, 16> FE;
8183     std::string StubEnc(Enc.substr(Start).str());
8184     StubEnc += '}';  // StubEnc now holds a valid incomplete TypeString.
8185     TSC.addIncomplete(ID, std::move(StubEnc));
8186     if (!extractFieldType(FE, RD, CGM, TSC)) {
8187       (void) TSC.removeIncomplete(ID);
8188       return false;
8189     }
8190     IsRecursive = TSC.removeIncomplete(ID);
8191     // The ABI requires unions to be sorted but not structures.
8192     // See FieldEncoding::operator< for sort algorithm.
8193     if (RT->isUnionType())
8194       std::sort(FE.begin(), FE.end());
8195     // We can now complete the TypeString.
8196     unsigned E = FE.size();
8197     for (unsigned I = 0; I != E; ++I) {
8198       if (I)
8199         Enc += ',';
8200       Enc += FE[I].str();
8201     }
8202   }
8203   Enc += '}';
8204   TSC.addIfComplete(ID, Enc.substr(Start), IsRecursive);
8205   return true;
8206 }
8207 
8208 /// Appends enum types to Enc and adds the encoding to the cache.
8209 static bool appendEnumType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const EnumType *ET,
8210                            TypeStringCache &TSC,
8211                            const IdentifierInfo *ID) {
8212   // Append the cached TypeString if we have one.
8213   StringRef TypeString = TSC.lookupStr(ID);
8214   if (!TypeString.empty()) {
8215     Enc += TypeString;
8216     return true;
8217   }
8218 
8219   size_t Start = Enc.size();
8220   Enc += "e(";
8221   if (ID)
8222     Enc += ID->getName();
8223   Enc += "){";
8224 
8225   // We collect all encoded enumerations and order them alphanumerically.
8226   if (const EnumDecl *ED = ET->getDecl()->getDefinition()) {
8227     SmallVector<FieldEncoding, 16> FE;
8228     for (auto I = ED->enumerator_begin(), E = ED->enumerator_end(); I != E;
8229          ++I) {
8230       SmallStringEnc EnumEnc;
8231       EnumEnc += "m(";
8232       EnumEnc += I->getName();
8233       EnumEnc += "){";
8234       I->getInitVal().toString(EnumEnc);
8235       EnumEnc += '}';
8236       FE.push_back(FieldEncoding(!I->getName().empty(), EnumEnc));
8237     }
8238     std::sort(FE.begin(), FE.end());
8239     unsigned E = FE.size();
8240     for (unsigned I = 0; I != E; ++I) {
8241       if (I)
8242         Enc += ',';
8243       Enc += FE[I].str();
8244     }
8245   }
8246   Enc += '}';
8247   TSC.addIfComplete(ID, Enc.substr(Start), false);
8248   return true;
8249 }
8250 
8251 /// Appends type's qualifier to Enc.
8252 /// This is done prior to appending the type's encoding.
8253 static void appendQualifier(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QT) {
8254   // Qualifiers are emitted in alphabetical order.
8255   static const char *const Table[]={"","c:","r:","cr:","v:","cv:","rv:","crv:"};
8256   int Lookup = 0;
8257   if (QT.isConstQualified())
8258     Lookup += 1<<0;
8259   if (QT.isRestrictQualified())
8260     Lookup += 1<<1;
8261   if (QT.isVolatileQualified())
8262     Lookup += 1<<2;
8263   Enc += Table[Lookup];
8264 }
8265 
8266 /// Appends built-in types to Enc.
8267 static bool appendBuiltinType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const BuiltinType *BT) {
8268   const char *EncType;
8269   switch (BT->getKind()) {
8270     case BuiltinType::Void:
8271       EncType = "0";
8272       break;
8273     case BuiltinType::Bool:
8274       EncType = "b";
8275       break;
8276     case BuiltinType::Char_U:
8277       EncType = "uc";
8278       break;
8279     case BuiltinType::UChar:
8280       EncType = "uc";
8281       break;
8282     case BuiltinType::SChar:
8283       EncType = "sc";
8284       break;
8285     case BuiltinType::UShort:
8286       EncType = "us";
8287       break;
8288     case BuiltinType::Short:
8289       EncType = "ss";
8290       break;
8291     case BuiltinType::UInt:
8292       EncType = "ui";
8293       break;
8294     case BuiltinType::Int:
8295       EncType = "si";
8296       break;
8297     case BuiltinType::ULong:
8298       EncType = "ul";
8299       break;
8300     case BuiltinType::Long:
8301       EncType = "sl";
8302       break;
8303     case BuiltinType::ULongLong:
8304       EncType = "ull";
8305       break;
8306     case BuiltinType::LongLong:
8307       EncType = "sll";
8308       break;
8309     case BuiltinType::Float:
8310       EncType = "ft";
8311       break;
8312     case BuiltinType::Double:
8313       EncType = "d";
8314       break;
8315     case BuiltinType::LongDouble:
8316       EncType = "ld";
8317       break;
8318     default:
8319       return false;
8320   }
8321   Enc += EncType;
8322   return true;
8323 }
8324 
8325 /// Appends a pointer encoding to Enc before calling appendType for the pointee.
8326 static bool appendPointerType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const PointerType *PT,
8327                               const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
8328                               TypeStringCache &TSC) {
8329   Enc += "p(";
8330   if (!appendType(Enc, PT->getPointeeType(), CGM, TSC))
8331     return false;
8332   Enc += ')';
8333   return true;
8334 }
8335 
8336 /// Appends array encoding to Enc before calling appendType for the element.
8337 static bool appendArrayType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QT,
8338                             const ArrayType *AT,
8339                             const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
8340                             TypeStringCache &TSC, StringRef NoSizeEnc) {
8341   if (AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Normal)
8342     return false;
8343   Enc += "a(";
8344   if (const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT))
8345     CAT->getSize().toStringUnsigned(Enc);
8346   else
8347     Enc += NoSizeEnc; // Global arrays use "*", otherwise it is "".
8348   Enc += ':';
8349   // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array.
8350   appendQualifier(Enc, QT);
8351   if (!appendType(Enc, AT->getElementType(), CGM, TSC))
8352     return false;
8353   Enc += ')';
8354   return true;
8355 }
8356 
8357 /// Appends a function encoding to Enc, calling appendType for the return type
8358 /// and the arguments.
8359 static bool appendFunctionType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const FunctionType *FT,
8360                              const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
8361                              TypeStringCache &TSC) {
8362   Enc += "f{";
8363   if (!appendType(Enc, FT->getReturnType(), CGM, TSC))
8364     return false;
8365   Enc += "}(";
8366   if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FT->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
8367     // N.B. we are only interested in the adjusted param types.
8368     auto I = FPT->param_type_begin();
8369     auto E = FPT->param_type_end();
8370     if (I != E) {
8371       do {
8372         if (!appendType(Enc, *I, CGM, TSC))
8373           return false;
8374         ++I;
8375         if (I != E)
8376           Enc += ',';
8377       } while (I != E);
8378       if (FPT->isVariadic())
8379         Enc += ",va";
8380     } else {
8381       if (FPT->isVariadic())
8382         Enc += "va";
8383       else
8384         Enc += '0';
8385     }
8386   }
8387   Enc += ')';
8388   return true;
8389 }
8390 
8391 /// Handles the type's qualifier before dispatching a call to handle specific
8392 /// type encodings.
8393 static bool appendType(SmallStringEnc &Enc, QualType QType,
8394                        const CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM,
8395                        TypeStringCache &TSC) {
8396 
8397   QualType QT = QType.getCanonicalType();
8398 
8399   if (const ArrayType *AT = QT->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe())
8400     // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array.
8401     // Thus we don't call appendQualifier() here.
8402     return appendArrayType(Enc, QT, AT, CGM, TSC, "");
8403 
8404   appendQualifier(Enc, QT);
8405 
8406   if (const BuiltinType *BT = QT->getAs<BuiltinType>())
8407     return appendBuiltinType(Enc, BT);
8408 
8409   if (const PointerType *PT = QT->getAs<PointerType>())
8410     return appendPointerType(Enc, PT, CGM, TSC);
8411 
8412   if (const EnumType *ET = QT->getAs<EnumType>())
8413     return appendEnumType(Enc, ET, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier());
8414 
8415   if (const RecordType *RT = QT->getAsStructureType())
8416     return appendRecordType(Enc, RT, CGM, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier());
8417 
8418   if (const RecordType *RT = QT->getAsUnionType())
8419     return appendRecordType(Enc, RT, CGM, TSC, QT.getBaseTypeIdentifier());
8420 
8421   if (const FunctionType *FT = QT->getAs<FunctionType>())
8422     return appendFunctionType(Enc, FT, CGM, TSC);
8423 
8424   return false;
8425 }
8426 
8427 static bool getTypeString(SmallStringEnc &Enc, const Decl *D,
8428                           CodeGen::CodeGenModule &CGM, TypeStringCache &TSC) {
8429   if (!D)
8430     return false;
8431 
8432   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
8433     if (FD->getLanguageLinkage() != CLanguageLinkage)
8434       return false;
8435     return appendType(Enc, FD->getType(), CGM, TSC);
8436   }
8437 
8438   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
8439     if (VD->getLanguageLinkage() != CLanguageLinkage)
8440       return false;
8441     QualType QT = VD->getType().getCanonicalType();
8442     if (const ArrayType *AT = QT->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()) {
8443       // Global ArrayTypes are given a size of '*' if the size is unknown.
8444       // The Qualifiers should be attached to the type rather than the array.
8445       // Thus we don't call appendQualifier() here.
8446       return appendArrayType(Enc, QT, AT, CGM, TSC, "*");
8447     }
8448     return appendType(Enc, QT, CGM, TSC);
8449   }
8450   return false;
8451 }
8452 
8453 
8454 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8455 // Driver code
8456 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8457 
8458 bool CodeGenModule::supportsCOMDAT() const {
8459   return getTriple().supportsCOMDAT();
8460 }
8461 
8462 const TargetCodeGenInfo &CodeGenModule::getTargetCodeGenInfo() {
8463   if (TheTargetCodeGenInfo)
8464     return *TheTargetCodeGenInfo;
8465 
8466   // Helper to set the unique_ptr while still keeping the return value.
8467   auto SetCGInfo = [&](TargetCodeGenInfo *P) -> const TargetCodeGenInfo & {
8468     this->TheTargetCodeGenInfo.reset(P);
8469     return *P;
8470   };
8471 
8472   const llvm::Triple &Triple = getTarget().getTriple();
8473   switch (Triple.getArch()) {
8474   default:
8475     return SetCGInfo(new DefaultTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8476 
8477   case llvm::Triple::le32:
8478     return SetCGInfo(new PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8479   case llvm::Triple::mips:
8480   case llvm::Triple::mipsel:
8481     if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::NaCl)
8482       return SetCGInfo(new PNaClTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8483     return SetCGInfo(new MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, true));
8484 
8485   case llvm::Triple::mips64:
8486   case llvm::Triple::mips64el:
8487     return SetCGInfo(new MIPSTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, false));
8488 
8489   case llvm::Triple::avr:
8490     return SetCGInfo(new AVRTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8491 
8492   case llvm::Triple::aarch64:
8493   case llvm::Triple::aarch64_be: {
8494     AArch64ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = AArch64ABIInfo::AAPCS;
8495     if (getTarget().getABI() == "darwinpcs")
8496       Kind = AArch64ABIInfo::DarwinPCS;
8497 
8498     return SetCGInfo(new AArch64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind));
8499   }
8500 
8501   case llvm::Triple::wasm32:
8502   case llvm::Triple::wasm64:
8503     return SetCGInfo(new WebAssemblyTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8504 
8505   case llvm::Triple::arm:
8506   case llvm::Triple::armeb:
8507   case llvm::Triple::thumb:
8508   case llvm::Triple::thumbeb: {
8509     if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::Win32) {
8510       return SetCGInfo(
8511           new WindowsARMTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP));
8512     }
8513 
8514     ARMABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS;
8515     StringRef ABIStr = getTarget().getABI();
8516     if (ABIStr == "apcs-gnu")
8517       Kind = ARMABIInfo::APCS;
8518     else if (ABIStr == "aapcs16")
8519       Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS16_VFP;
8520     else if (CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "hard" ||
8521              (CodeGenOpts.FloatABI != "soft" &&
8522               (Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::GNUEABIHF ||
8523                Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::MuslEABIHF ||
8524                Triple.getEnvironment() == llvm::Triple::EABIHF)))
8525       Kind = ARMABIInfo::AAPCS_VFP;
8526 
8527     return SetCGInfo(new ARMTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind));
8528   }
8529 
8530   case llvm::Triple::ppc:
8531     return SetCGInfo(
8532         new PPC32TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft"));
8533   case llvm::Triple::ppc64:
8534     if (Triple.isOSBinFormatELF()) {
8535       PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv1;
8536       if (getTarget().getABI() == "elfv2")
8537         Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv2;
8538       bool HasQPX = getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx";
8539       bool IsSoftFloat = CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft";
8540 
8541       return SetCGInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind, HasQPX,
8542                                                         IsSoftFloat));
8543     } else
8544       return SetCGInfo(new PPC64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8545   case llvm::Triple::ppc64le: {
8546     assert(Triple.isOSBinFormatELF() && "PPC64 LE non-ELF not supported!");
8547     PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ABIKind Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv2;
8548     if (getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1" || getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx")
8549       Kind = PPC64_SVR4_ABIInfo::ELFv1;
8550     bool HasQPX = getTarget().getABI() == "elfv1-qpx";
8551     bool IsSoftFloat = CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft";
8552 
8553     return SetCGInfo(new PPC64_SVR4_TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, Kind, HasQPX,
8554                                                       IsSoftFloat));
8555   }
8556 
8557   case llvm::Triple::nvptx:
8558   case llvm::Triple::nvptx64:
8559     return SetCGInfo(new NVPTXTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8560 
8561   case llvm::Triple::msp430:
8562     return SetCGInfo(new MSP430TargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8563 
8564   case llvm::Triple::systemz: {
8565     bool HasVector = getTarget().getABI() == "vector";
8566     return SetCGInfo(new SystemZTargetCodeGenInfo(Types, HasVector));
8567   }
8568 
8569   case llvm::Triple::tce:
8570   case llvm::Triple::tcele:
8571     return SetCGInfo(new TCETargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8572 
8573   case llvm::Triple::x86: {
8574     bool IsDarwinVectorABI = Triple.isOSDarwin();
8575     bool RetSmallStructInRegABI =
8576         X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo::isStructReturnInRegABI(Triple, CodeGenOpts);
8577     bool IsWin32FloatStructABI = Triple.isOSWindows() && !Triple.isOSCygMing();
8578 
8579     if (Triple.getOS() == llvm::Triple::Win32) {
8580       return SetCGInfo(new WinX86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(
8581           Types, IsDarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI,
8582           IsWin32FloatStructABI, CodeGenOpts.NumRegisterParameters));
8583     } else {
8584       return SetCGInfo(new X86_32TargetCodeGenInfo(
8585           Types, IsDarwinVectorABI, RetSmallStructInRegABI,
8586           IsWin32FloatStructABI, CodeGenOpts.NumRegisterParameters,
8587           CodeGenOpts.FloatABI == "soft"));
8588     }
8589   }
8590 
8591   case llvm::Triple::x86_64: {
8592     StringRef ABI = getTarget().getABI();
8593     X86AVXABILevel AVXLevel =
8594         (ABI == "avx512"
8595              ? X86AVXABILevel::AVX512
8596              : ABI == "avx" ? X86AVXABILevel::AVX : X86AVXABILevel::None);
8597 
8598     switch (Triple.getOS()) {
8599     case llvm::Triple::Win32:
8600       return SetCGInfo(new WinX86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel));
8601     case llvm::Triple::PS4:
8602       return SetCGInfo(new PS4TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel));
8603     default:
8604       return SetCGInfo(new X86_64TargetCodeGenInfo(Types, AVXLevel));
8605     }
8606   }
8607   case llvm::Triple::hexagon:
8608     return SetCGInfo(new HexagonTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8609   case llvm::Triple::lanai:
8610     return SetCGInfo(new LanaiTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8611   case llvm::Triple::r600:
8612     return SetCGInfo(new AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8613   case llvm::Triple::amdgcn:
8614     return SetCGInfo(new AMDGPUTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8615   case llvm::Triple::sparc:
8616     return SetCGInfo(new SparcV8TargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8617   case llvm::Triple::sparcv9:
8618     return SetCGInfo(new SparcV9TargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8619   case llvm::Triple::xcore:
8620     return SetCGInfo(new XCoreTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8621   case llvm::Triple::spir:
8622   case llvm::Triple::spir64:
8623     return SetCGInfo(new SPIRTargetCodeGenInfo(Types));
8624   }
8625 }
8626